FTI Consulting, Inc. Form S-3/A
Table of Contents

As filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on February 5, 2003

Registration No. 333-100428


SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION

WASHINGTON, D.C. 20549

 


AMENDMENT NO. 3 to

FORM S-3

REGISTRATION STATEMENT

UNDER

THE SECURITIES ACT OF 1933

 


FTI CONSULTING, INC.

(Exact name of registrant as specified in its charter)

 


900 Bestgate Road, Suite 100

Annapolis, MD 21401

(410) 224-8770

(Address of principal executive offices)

 

Maryland

 

52-1261113

(State or other jurisdiction of incorporation or organization)

 

(I.R.S. employer identification number)

 


Jack B. Dunn, IV

Chairman of the Board and

Chief Executive Officer

FTI Consulting, Inc.

900 Bestgate Road, Suite 100

Annapolis, MD 21401

(410) 224-8770

(Name, address, including zip code and telephone number, including area code of agent for service)

 


Copies to:

 

Richard C. Tilghman, Jr., Esquire

 

Kevin P. Kennedy, Esquire

Piper Rudnick LLP

 

Simpson Thacher & Bartlett

6225 Smith Avenue

 

3330 Hillview Avenue

Baltimore, Maryland 21209

 

Palo Alto, California 94304

(410) 580-3000

 

(650) 251-5000

 


 

Approximate date of commencement of proposed sale to the public:    As soon as practicable after this Registration Statement becomes effective.

 

If the only securities being registered on this Form are being offered pursuant to dividend or interest reinvestment plans, please check the following box. ¨

 

If any of the securities being registered on this form are to be offered on a delayed or continuous basis pursuant to Rule 415 under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended (the “Securities Act”) check the following box.    ¨

 

If this Form is filed to register additional securities for an offering pursuant to Rule 462(b) under the Securities Act, check the following box and list the Securities Act registration statement number of the earlier effective registration statement for the same offering. ¨              

 

If this Form is a post-effective amendment filed pursuant to Rule 462(c) under the Securities Act, check the following box and list the Securities Act registration statement number of the earlier effective registration statement for the same offering. ¨              

 

If this Form is a post-effective amendment filed pursuant to Rule 462(d) under the Securities Act, check the following box and list the Securities Act registration statement number of the earlier effective registration statement for the same offering. ¨              

 

If delivery of the prospectus is expected to be made pursuant to Rule 434, please check the following box. ¨

 


 


Title of Each Class of

Securities To Be Registered

  

Amount
To Be
Registered(1)

    

Proposed
Maximum
Offering Price
Per Share(2)

    

Proposed
Maximum
Aggregate
Offering Price

    

Amount of
Registration Fee


Common Stock, par value $0.01

  

2,875 shares

    

$40.96

    

$117,760

    

$11



(1) Includes 375 shares of common stock which may be purchased by the underwriters to cover over-allotments, if any. We previously paid the fee for the registration of 2,437,389 shares of our common stock.
(2) Estimated solely for purposes of determining the registration fee pursuant to Rule 457 under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, based on the closing price of our common stock of $40.96 on February 4, 2003, as reported on the New York Stock Exchange.

 


 

The registrant hereby amends this registration statement on such date or dates as may be necessary to delay its effective date until the registrant shall file a further amendment which specifically states that this registration statement shall thereafter become effective in accordance with Section 8(a) of the Securities Act, or until the registration statement shall become effective on such date as the Commission, acting pursuant to said Section 8(a), may determine.

 



Table of Contents

The information in this prospectus is not complete and may be changed. We may not sell these securities until the registration statement filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission is effective. This prospectus is not an offer to sell these securities and is not soliciting an offer to buy these securities in any state where the offer or sale is not permitted.

 

Subject to Completion, dated February 5, 2003

 

PROSPECTUS

 

 

2,121,969 Shares

 

 

 

LOGO

 

FTI Consulting, Inc.

 

Common Stock

 


 

FTI Consulting, Inc. is offering 2,100,000 shares of common stock and the selling stockholders are offering 21,969 shares of common stock by this prospectus. We will not receive any of the proceeds from the shares sold by the selling stockholders.

 

Our common stock is listed on the New York Stock Exchange under the symbol “FCN.” The last reported sale price of our common stock on February 4, 2003 was $40.96 per share.

 

Investing in our common stock involves risks. See “Risk Factors” beginning on page 8.

 

      

Per Share


    

Total


Public Offering Price

    

$

                

    

$

                

Underwriting Discounts and Commissions

    

$

 

    

$

 

Proceeds to FTI Consulting, Inc. (before expenses)

    

$

 

    

$

 

Proceeds to Selling Stockholders

    

$

 

    

$

 

 

We have granted the underwriters the right to purchase up to 318,295 additional shares of common stock to cover any over-allotments.

 

Neither the Securities and Exchange Commission nor any state securities commission has approved or disapproved of these securities or determined if this prospectus is truthful or complete. Any representation to the contrary is a criminal offense.

 

Lehman Brothers, on behalf of the underwriters, expects to deliver the common stock on or about            , 2003.

 


 

LEHMAN BROTHERS

 

BANC OF AMERICA SECURITIES LLC

 

ADAMS, HARKNESS & HILL, INC.

 

JANNEY MONTGOMERY SCOTT LLC

 

SUNTRUST ROBINSON HUMPHREY

 

                             , 2003


Table of Contents

 

TABLE OF CONTENTS

 

    

Page


Summary

  

1

Risk Factors

  

8

Use of Proceeds

  

15

Price Range of Common Stock and Dividend Policy

  

16

Capitalization

  

17

Unaudited Pro Forma Consolidated Statements of Income

  

18

Selected Financial Data

  

23

Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations

  

26

Business

  

34

Management

  

43

Description of Capital Stock

  

45

Principal and Selling Stockholders

  

48

Certain United States Tax Consequences to Non-U.S. Holders

  

50

Underwriting

  

52

Legal Matters

  

57

Experts

  

57

Where You Can Find More Information

  

57

Incorporation by Reference

  

58

Index to Financial Statements

  

F-1

 


 

You should rely only on the information contained in this document or in those documents to which we refer you. We and the underwriters have not authorized anyone to provide you with additional or different information. This document may only be used where it is legal to sell these securities. The information in this document is accurate only as of the date of this document, regardless of the time of its delivery or of any sale of common stock.

 


 

 

i


Table of Contents

 

SUMMARY

 

This summary highlights selected information from this prospectus. It may not contain all the information that is important to you. To understand this offering fully, you should carefully read the entire prospectus, including the risk factors and the financial statements and related notes. Unless the context requires otherwise, in this prospectus, “FTI,” “we,” “us” and “our” refer to FTI Consulting, Inc. and its subsidiaries, “BRS” refers to the U.S. Business Recovery Services Division of PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP (excluding the broker-dealer business of that division), which we acquired on August 30, 2002, and “PwC” refers to U.S. PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP.

 

The information in this prospectus, unless otherwise indicated, assumes that the underwriters will not exercise their option to purchase additional shares.

 

Our Business

 

We are one of the largest U.S. providers of turnaround, restructuring, bankruptcy and related consulting services. Our highly skilled professionals assist distressed companies in improving their financial position or their creditors or other stakeholders in maximizing recovery of their claims. We assist our clients in exploring and implementing the various strategic alternatives available to troubled companies. Our professionals have extensive experience in crisis management, negotiations of complex mergers, acquisitions and capital restructurings, as well as the liquidation of surplus assets.

 

We also help clients in all phases of the litigation process. We assist our clients in refining issues relating to litigation and venue selection, and provide fraud investigation, securities litigation assistance, trial graphics and technology and electronic evidence services. Furthermore, we provide forensic accounting and economic consulting services. In recent months, we have begun initiatives in the areas of mergers and acquisitions and dispute settlement services.

 

Through a combination of organic growth and acquisitions, our revenues from continuing operations have grown from $32.2 million in 1997 to $122.3 million in 2001. From 1997 through 2001, our income from continuing operations has grown from $1.2 million to $12.9 million during the same period. In 2001, we had $289.6 million in revenues from continuing operations and $30.9 million in income from continuing operations, each on a pro forma basis, which includes BRS revenues but excludes revenues from our applied sciences practice group, which we have announced our intention to sell. For the first nine months of 2002, we had $133.6 million in revenues from continuing operations and $19.4 million in income from continuing operations, each on an actual basis. For that same period, we had $242.6 million in revenues from continuing operations and $30.0 million in income from continuing operations, each on a pro forma basis. The benefits BRS enjoyed when it was part of PwC will no longer be available after our acquisition of BRS and thus may harm the profitability of BRS.

 

Our clients include troubled companies and financial institutions and the law firms that represent them. Our services typically represent non-discretionary engagements for businesses facing decisions that are critical to their survival. We are regularly engaged by the largest banks in the U.S., including Bank of America, N.A., Wachovia, N.A. and JP Morgan Chase Bank. We are currently providing our services in connection with the largest bankruptcy proceedings and out-of-court restructurings in the U.S., including the bankruptcies of Enron Corp., WorldCom, Inc., US Airways, Inc. and Adelphia Communications Corporation.

 

We believe demand for our services will continue to be strong, driven by a number of current and anticipated trends, including:

 

    high debt default rates and ongoing bankruptcy filings;

 

    continuing use of debt for corporate financings;

 

1


Table of Contents

 

    escalating competitive and regulatory complexity faced by businesses;

 

    the current wave of corporate reform legislation that encourages, and in some cases, requires the use of outside financial consultants; and

 

    the need for objective, independent expertise for critical, business processes.

 

We believe that our reputation, national scale and large staff of highly qualified professionals position us well to capitalize on the trends that we believe will drive the growth in our industry.

 

Bank of America, N.A. and SunTrust Bank, as lenders under our credit facility, will collectively receive 64% of repayment of debt outstanding under our credit facility from the net proceeds we receive from this offering. We expect to apply half of the net proceeds we receive from this offering to repay our lenders under our term loan facility and the remainder of these proceeds first to the repayment of the amounts, if any, outstanding under our revolving credit facility and then for general corporate purposes. As of December 31, 2002, no amounts were outstanding under our revolving credit facility. Based on an estimated per share offering price of $40.96, we expect to repay $19.6 million and $6.0 million, respectively, to Bank of America and Sun Trust Bank. Each of these lenders is affiliated with an underwriter of this offering.

 

Business Strategy

 

We intend to continue to provide high caliber financial consulting services on even the most complex assignments. We also intend to expand the range of consulting services we offer. The following are the key elements of our business strategy:

 

    maintain high utilization rates among all of our professionals;

 

    maintain a sufficient staff of highly qualified professionals to enable us to handle a number of large, complex assignments simultaneously;

 

    successfully utilize our reputation, experience and client base to obtain a greater number of engagements from both existing and new clients;

 

    diversify our range of service offerings, including further development of new practice areas such as lender and transactional support, dispute settlement, intellectual property consulting and mergers and acquisitions advice, in order to better insulate our business from changing market demands; and

 

    selectively pursue strategic acquisitions to expand our range of consulting services, expand our staff of expert professionals and add new clients to which we can sell our existing services.

 

Our Company

 

We were incorporated in Maryland in 1982 and completed our initial public offering of common stock in May 1996. Our executive offices are located at 900 Bestgate Road, Suite 100, Annapolis, Maryland 21401. Our telephone number is (410) 224-8770. Our website is located at www.fticonsulting.com. Information contained on our website does not constitute part of this prospectus.

 

Recent Developments

 

Acquisition of BRS

 

On August 30, 2002, we acquired BRS for $141.3 million in cash and 3,000,000 shares of our common stock valued at $101.9 million. BRS had revenues of $179.3 million and operating income of $66.8 million for its fiscal year ended June 30, 2002. On a pro forma basis, as adjusted to present BRS as a company separate from PwC, BRS had revenues of $167.2 million and operating income of $40.0 million for the year ended December 31, 2001, and revenues of $109.0 million and operating income of $24.0 million for the eight-month period ended August 30, 2002.

 

2


Table of Contents

 

Our acquisition of BRS greatly enhances our ability to provide consulting services in the largest and most complex U.S. turnarounds, restructurings and bankruptcies. The BRS professionals have developed a premier practice handling turnarounds, restructurings and bankruptcies of comparable scale and complexity as we have. As a result of the acquisition of BRS, we have added 371 professionals, including the 49 BRS partners that we hired, to our pool of talented, experienced professionals. The BRS acquisition also significantly diversifies our client base. Immediately after the acquisition, we began integrating BRS into our turnaround, restructuring and bankruptcy practice group.

 

Intended Sale of Our Applied Sciences Practice Group

 

In connection with the BRS acquisition, we have decided to sell our applied sciences practice group because the practice is no longer a core part of our business. As of December 31, 2002, we sold a part of the applied sciences practice group for a total consideration of $4.2 million, including a seven year note of $2.0 million. We incurred a loss after taxes of $891,000 in connection with this sale. We expect to complete the sale of the entire applied sciences practice group by the end of 2003. We intend to use the proceeds from the sale to reduce our outstanding debt under our credit facility. However, we cannot assure you that we will be able to sell our entire applied sciences practice group within the stated timeframe or at what price we will be able to sell it. Depending on the sale price and the tax structure of the transaction, the amount realized after taxes from the sale may be less than the carrying value. For the nine months ended September 30, 2002, our applied sciences practice group reported income from operations of discontinued operations, net of income taxes, of $2.8 million.

 

Fourth Quarter and Year End Results From Continuing Operations

 

For the three month period ended December 31, 2002, our revenues from continuing operations were $90.6 million, an increase of 197.0% compared to $30.5 million for the comparable period in 2001; our income from continuing operations grew 278.4% to $15.5 million from $4.1 million in the comparable quarter last year; and earnings per share from continuing operations grew 210.0 percent to $0.62 on a diluted basis compared to $0.20 in the comparable quarter last year. For the three month period ended December 31, 2002, the increase in our earnings per share from continuing operations would have been 148.0% if the non-amortization provisions of SFAS 142, Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets, had been in effect in the fourth quarter of 2001. For the three month period ended December 31, 2002, our earnings from continuing operations before interest, taxes, depreciation and amortization (EBITDA) were $30.3 million compared with $9.5 million in the comparable period in the prior year, an increase of 216.9%. Including the discontinued operations for the applied sciences practice group, our earnings per share on a diluted basis were $0.60 for the three month period ended December 31, 2002.

 

In 2002, our revenues from continuing operations were $224.1 million, an increase of 83.2% compared to $122.3 million for 2001; our income from continuing operations grew 169.6% to $34.9 million from $12.9 million last year; and our earnings per share from continuing operations grew 131.8% to $1.53 on a diluted basis compared with $0.66 last year. In 2002, the increase in our earnings per share from continuing operations would have been 96.2% if the non-amortization provisions of SFAS 142, Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets, had been in effect in 2001. In 2002, our EBITDA was $68.7 million compared to $33.4 million in the prior year, an increase of 105.6%. Our cash flow provided by operations for 2002 was approximately $77.6 million compared with $35.4 million in the prior year. Including the discontinued operations for the applied science practice group, our earnings per share on a diluted basis were $1.63 for 2002.

 

At December 31, 2002, we had cash and cash equivalents of $9.9 million on our balance sheet and our total long-term debt was $97.8 million. The $45.0 million drawn down under our $100.0 million revolving line of credit in connection with the acquisition of BRS on August 31, 2002 has been repaid and no amounts were outstanding under the revolving line of credit at December 31, 2002.

 

3


Table of Contents

 

Risk Factors

 

You should carefully consider each of the risks described in this prospectus and all of the other information in this prospectus and the documents we incorporate by reference before you decide to buy our common stock. Additional risks and uncertainties not currently known to us may also harm our business, financial condition or results of operations. If any of these risks or uncertainties occurs, the trading price of our common stock could decline, and you may lose all or part of the money you paid to buy our common stock. Listed below are the most material risks related to our business and our recent acquisition of BRS that you should consider:

 

    If we fail to retain our qualified professionals or hire additional qualified professionals, our future growth and financial performance may suffer.

 

    Our profitability will suffer if we are not able to maintain our utilization and pricing rates.

 

    A significant portion of BRS’ revenues results from relationships with clients and industry professionals maintained by a small number of our key professionals. The loss of one or more of these key professionals could decrease our revenues and our profitability.

 

    We cannot assure you that we can successfully integrate BRS into our business.

 

    We have a different system of governance and management from PwC, which could cause some of our key personnel to leave us.

 

    The benefits BRS enjoyed when it was part of PwC will no longer be available, and this could harm the profitability of BRS.

 

4


Table of Contents

The Offering

 

Common stock offered by FTI Consulting, Inc.

  

2,100,000 shares

Common stock offered by the selling stockholders

  

21,969 shares

Total shares offered

  

2,121,969 shares

Common stock to be outstanding after this offering

  

26,210,980 shares

Use of proceeds

  

We will use half of the net proceeds that we receive from this offering to repay amounts outstanding under the term loan portion of our credit facility and the remainder to repay amounts, if any, outstanding under our revolving credit facility and for general corporate purposes. We will not receive any proceeds from the sale of shares by the selling stockholders.

New York Stock Exchange symbol

  

FCN

 

The number of shares of our common stock to be outstanding after this offering is based on 24,110,980 shares outstanding at January 10, 2003. The number of outstanding shares excludes:

 

    644,404 shares of our common stock reserved for future option awards or stock grants under our stock option plans;

 

    3,784,726 shares of our common stock reserved for issuance upon exercise of stock options outstanding under our stock option plans with a weighted average exercise price of $22.70 per share at January 10, 2003; and

 

    235,496 shares of our common stock reserved for future grants under our employee stock purchase plan.

 

5


Table of Contents

Summary Historical Consolidated and Unaudited

Pro Forma Consolidated Financial and Other Data

 

The following summary historical consolidated and unaudited pro forma consolidated financial and other data present our:

 

    audited historical consolidated statement of income and other data for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2001;

 

    unaudited historical consolidated statement of income and other data for the nine-month periods ended September 30, 2001 and 2002;

 

    unaudited pro forma consolidated statement of income data for the year ended December 31, 2001 and for the nine-month period ended September 30, 2002; and

 

    unaudited historical consolidated and as adjusted balance sheet data at September 30, 2002.

 

Our unaudited pro forma consolidated statement of income data for the year ended December 31, 2001 and the nine months ended September 30, 2002 give effect to the acquisition of BRS, including the assumed effects of the debt financing transactions related to the acquisition, as if the acquisition had occurred on January 1, 2001.

 

Our unaudited as adjusted balance sheet data at September 30, 2002 give effect to the receipt of the estimated net proceeds from the sale of 2,100,000 shares of our common stock by us in this offering and the assumed application of these proceeds on that date to repay $80.3 million of our debt under our credit facility. At September 30, 2002, our total long-term debt was $138.9 million and our long-term debt at December 31, 2002 was $97.8 million. We intend to apply half of the net proceeds of this offering to repay our lenders under our term loan facility and the remainder to repay any amounts then outstanding under our revolving credit facility and for general corporate purposes. At December 31, 2002, no amounts were outstanding under our revolving credit facility.

 

The pro forma adjustments are described in the notes accompanying the unaudited pro forma consolidated statements of income beginning on page 18 and are based upon available information and various assumptions that management believes are reasonable. These adjustments give effect to events directly attributable to the transactions and do not reflect any restructuring or integration related costs, or any potential cost savings or other synergies that management expects to realize as a result of the transaction. The unaudited pro forma consolidated statements of income do not purport to represent what our financial position and results of operations would actually have been had these transactions occurred on January 1, 2001.

 

You should also refer to our historical consolidated financial statements and the historical financial statements of BRS, which we have included elsewhere in this prospectus.

 

6


Table of Contents

 

Statement of Income and Other Data:

 

    

Year ended December 31,


    

Nine months ended September 30,


 
    

Historical


    

Pro Forma 2001


    

Historical


    

Pro Forma 2002


 
    

1999


    

2000


    

2001


       

2001


    

2002


    
    

(in thousands, except percentages and per share data)

 

Revenues

  

$

48,914

 

  

$

95,532

 

  

$

122,317

 

  

$

289,561

 

  

$

91,826

 

  

$

133,556

 

  

$

242,577

 

Direct cost of revenues

  

 

25,600

 

  

 

48,979

 

  

 

59,074

 

  

 

166,151

 

  

 

46,704

 

  

 

65,512

 

  

 

133,248

 

Selling, general and administrative expenses

  

 

16,532

 

  

 

23,920

 

  

 

33,085

 

  

 

53,284

 

  

 

23,608

 

  

 

32,796

 

  

 

50,120

 

Amortization expense

  

 

1,554

 

  

 

3,942

 

  

 

4,235

 

  

 

7,635

 

  

 

3,156

 

  

 

252

 

  

 

2,519

 

    


  


  


  


  


  


  


Total costs and expenses

  

 

43,686

 

  

 

76,841

 

  

 

96,394

 

  

 

227,070

 

  

 

73,468

 

  

 

98,560

 

  

 

185,887

 

    


  


  


  


  


  


  


Operating income

  

 

5,228

 

  

 

18,691

 

  

 

25,923

 

  

 

62,491

 

  

 

18,358

 

  

 

34,996

 

  

 

56,690

 

Interest expense, net

  

 

(4,014

)

  

 

(10,771

)

  

 

(4,356

)

  

 

(11,017

)

  

 

(3,533

)

  

 

(2,582

)

  

 

(6,567

)

    


  


  


  


  


  


  


Income from continuing operations before income taxes and extraordinary item

  

 

1,214

 

  

 

7,920

 

  

 

21,567

 

  

 

51,474

 

  

 

14,825

 

  

 

32,414

 

  

 

50,123

 

Income taxes

  

 

402

 

  

 

3,262

 

  

 

8,621

 

  

 

20,584

 

  

 

6,148

 

  

 

13,021

 

  

 

20,105

 

    


  


  


  


  


  


  


Income from continuing operations before
extraordinary item

  

$

812

 

  

$

4,658

 

  

$

12,946

 

  

$

30,890

 

  

$

8,677

 

  

$

19,393

 

  

$

30,018

 

    


  


  


  


  


  


  


Net income

  

$

2,991

 

  

$

2,561

 

  

$

16,469

 

           

$

11,633

 

  

$

22,184

 

        
    


  


  


           


  


        

Income from continuing operations before extraordinary item per share, diluted

  

$

0.11

 

  

$

0.39

 

  

$

0.66

 

  

$

1.36

 

  

$

0.45

 

  

$

0.88

 

  

$

1.22

 

    


  


  


  


  


  


  


Earnings per common
share, diluted

  

$

0.39

 

  

$

0.21

 

  

$

0.84

 

           

$

0.60

 

  

$

1.01

 

        
    


  


  


           


  


        

Weighted average shares outstanding, diluted

  

 

7,543

 

  

 

11,988

 

  

 

19,631

 

  

 

22,631

 

  

 

19,229

 

  

 

22,011

 

  

 

24,659

 

    


  


  


  


  


  


  


EBITDA (1)

  

$

8,595

 

  

$

24,865

 

  

$

33,399

 

  

$

73,367

 

  

$

23,851

 

  

$

38,404

 

  

$

62,367

 

    


  


  


  


  


  


  


EBITDA margin (2)

  

 

17.6

%

  

 

26.0

%

  

 

27.3

%

  

 

25.3

%

  

 

26.0

%

  

 

28.8

%

  

 

25.7

%

    


  


  


  


  


  


  


 

Balance Sheet Data:

 

    

At September 30, 2002


    

Historical


  

As Adjusted


Cash and cash equivalents

  

$

3,618

  

$

3,618

Working capital

  

 

15,049

  

 

15,049

Total assets

  

 

447,015

  

 

447,015

Total debt

  

 

138,916

  

 

58,631

Total stockholders’ equity

  

 

246,205

  

 

326,490


(1) EBITDA refers to earnings before taxes, net interest expense and depreciation and amortization. Because all companies do not calculate EBITDA or similarly titled financial measures in the same manner, other companies’ disclosures of EBITDA may not be comparable with EBITDA as we calculate it. EBITDA should not be considered as an alternative to net income or loss (as an indicator of operating performance) or as an alternative to cash flow (as a measure of liquidity or ability to service debt obligations) and is not a measure of performance or financial condition under generally accepted accounting principles. EBITDA is intended to provide additional information for evaluating the ability of an entity to meet its financial obligations.
(2) EBITDA margin equals EBITDA divided by our total revenues for each period presented, in percentage format.

 

7


Table of Contents

RISK FACTORS

 

You should carefully consider each of the following risks and all of the other information in this prospectus and the documents we incorporate by reference before you decide to buy our common stock. Additional risks and uncertainties not currently known to us may also harm our business, financial condition or results of operations. If any of these risks or uncertainties occurs, the trading price of our common stock could decline, and you may lose all or part of the money you paid to buy our common stock.

 

We have made statements in this prospectus and in documents incorporated by reference into this prospectus that constitute forward-looking statements, as that term is defined in the Private Securities Litigation Reform Act of 1995. These statements are subject to risks and uncertainties. These forward-looking statements generally are accompanied by words such as “believe,” “intend,” “anticipate,” “estimate,” “expect,” “should,” “could,” “may,” “will” or similar expressions. You should understand that these forward-looking statements are subject to a number of assumptions, risks and uncertainties that could cause actual results to differ materially from those expressed or implied in the forward-looking statements. Important factors that could cause actual results to differ materially from estimates or projections contained in forward-looking statements include the below described risk factors.

 

Risks Related to Our Business

 

If we fail to retain our qualified professionals or hire additional qualified professionals, our future growth and financial performance may suffer.

 

Our business involves the delivery of professional turnaround, restructuring, bankruptcy and related consulting services. In the consulting business, professional acumen is a critical element of a company’s ability to deliver high quality professional services. Our professionals have highly specialized skills. Our continued success depends upon our ability to retain and expand our staff of professionals who have reputations and client relationships critical to maintaining and developing our business. We face intense competition in recruiting and retaining the highly qualified professionals we must have to continue our service offerings. We cannot assure you that we will be able to retain our existing professionals or that in the future we will be able to attract and retain enough qualified professionals to maintain or expand our business. Moreover, competition for retaining or hiring qualified professionals could increase our costs of labor, a trend which could harm our margins and results of operations.

 

Our profitability will suffer if we are not able to maintain our utilization and pricing rates.

 

We calculate the utilization rate for our professional staff by dividing the number of hours all of our professionals charged our clients during a year by the total available working hours for all of our professionals assuming a 40-hour work week and a 52-week year. The hourly rates we charge our clients for our services and the number of hours our professionals are able to charge our clients for our services are affected by the level of expertise and experience of the professionals working on a particular engagement and, to a lesser extent, the pricing and staffing policies of our competitors. If we fail to maintain an appropriate utilization rate for our professionals and maintain or increase the hourly rates we charge our clients for our services, our profitability will suffer.

 

We rely heavily on our senior management team and practice group leaders for the success of our business.

 

We rely heavily upon our senior management team and practice group leaders to manage our turnaround, restructuring, bankruptcy and related consulting business. Given the highly specialized nature of our services and the scale of our operations, these people must have a thorough understanding of our service offerings as well as

 

8


Table of Contents

the skills and experience necessary to manage a large organization. If one or more members of our senior management team or our practice group leaders leave and we cannot replace them with a suitable candidate quickly, we could experience difficulty in managing our business properly, and this could harm our business prospects and results of operations.

 

We face intense competition in our business. If we fail to compete effectively, we may miss new business opportunities or lose existing clients, and our revenues and profitability may decline.

 

The market for our consulting services is highly competitive. Our competitors range from large organizations, such as the national accounting firms and the large management consulting companies that offer a broad range of consulting services, to small firms and independent contractors that provide one specialized service. Some of our competitors have significantly more financial resources, larger professional staffs and greater brand recognition than we do. We cannot assure you that we will continue to compete successfully for new business opportunities or retain our existing clients. Although, in connection with our acquisition of BRS, we obtained a limited noncompetition arrangement from PwC, we cannot assure that PwC will not compete with us in the future. For information on our noncompetition arrangement with PwC, see “Business—Our Acquisition of BRS.”

 

Any claims involving the quality of our services could harm our overall professional reputation, which could harm our ability to compete for new business opportunities or in hiring qualified professionals.

 

Many of our engagements involve complex analysis and the exercise of professional judgment. Therefore, we are subject to the risk of professional liability. Often, our engagements involve matters that, if resolved unfavorably, may result in a severe impact on the client’s business, cause the client a substantial monetary loss or prevent the client from pursuing business opportunities. Since our ability to generate new client engagements depends upon our ability to maintain a high degree of client satisfaction as well as our reputation among industry professionals, any claims against us involving the quality of our services may be more damaging than similar claims against businesses in other industries.

 

Any claim by a client against us could expose us to professional liability in excess of our insurance limits. We maintain a limited amount of liability insurance. The damages and/or expenses resulting from any successful claims against us in excess of our insurance limits would have to be borne directly by us and could seriously harm our profitability and financial resources.

 

Our clients may terminate our engagements with little or no notice, which may cause us to experience unexpected declines in our profitability.

 

Much of our business involves large client engagements that we staff with a substantial number of professionals. We typically enter into engagement letters with clients but these letters do not obligate clients to continue to use our services. Typically, our engagement letters permit clients to terminate our services at any time. If our clients unexpectedly cancel engagements with us or curtail the scope of our engagements, we may be unable to replace the lost revenues from those engagements and may also be unable to quickly eliminate costs associated with those engagements. Any decrease in revenues without a corresponding reduction in our costs will likely harm our profitability.

 

Our turnaround, restructuring and bankruptcy practice group has an increased risk of fee nonpayment.

 

Many of our clients have engaged us because they are experiencing financial distress. We recognize that these clients may not have sufficient funds to continue operations or to pay for our services. Despite requiring clients to pay us retainers before we begin performing services on their behalf, we cannot assure you that these retainers will adequately cover our fees for the services we perform on behalf of these clients. We are not always able to obtain retainers from clients in bankruptcy as the bankruptcy court must approve our retainer for those

 

9


Table of Contents

clients. Even if a bankruptcy court approves our retainer, the court may subsequently require us to return all or a portion of it. Therefore, we face the risk of nonpayment, which can result in write-offs. For the three years ended December 31, 2001, we wrote off a total of $4.6 million of uncollectible fees, not including amounts attributable to our applied sciences practice group. If we were to experience more write-offs than we expect in any period, our results of operations could be harmed.

 

If the number of debt defaults, bankruptcies or other factors affecting demand for our services declines, our revenues and profitability could suffer.

 

Our turnaround, restructuring and bankruptcy practice group is our largest practice group. It provides various restructuring and restructuring-related services to companies in financial distress or their creditors or other stakeholders. A number of factors affects demand for this practice group’s services. These include:

 

    the level of lending activity and over-leveraging of companies;

 

    over-expansion by various businesses;

 

    increases in merger and acquisition activity;

 

    management problems; and

 

    the general decline in the economy in the U.S. during the past several years.

 

If demand for our restructuring services decreases, our turnaround, restructuring and bankruptcy practice group could suffer a decline in revenues, which would lower our overall profitability. Since most of the clients of BRS are financially distressed companies requiring turnaround, restructuring and bankruptcy services, our acquisition of BRS may increase our exposure to the risk of decreased demand for our services.

 

We may be unable to develop profitable new service offerings, and our overall profitability may suffer.

 

As a key part of our strategy, we have been developing new service offerings in addition to our practice group areas of restructuring, forensic accounting and trial support consulting. Developing new service offerings involves inherent risks, including:

 

    our inability to estimate demand for the new service offerings;

 

    competition from more established market participants;

 

    a lack of market understanding; and

 

    unanticipated expenses to recruit and hire qualified professionals and to market our new service offerings.

 

If we cannot manage these risks effectively, we are unlikely to be successful in our efforts to develop new service offerings profitably. This inability could harm our overall business, financial condition and results of operations.

 

If we fail to find suitable acquisition candidates, our ability to expand may be curtailed.

 

We may experience an increased level of competition in our efforts to make acquisitions in the future. As a result, we may be unable to continue to make acquisitions or be forced to pay more for the companies that we are able to acquire. In either case, we may be unable to grow our business as quickly as we have in the past, and our profitability may decline. Our ability to grow our business, particularly through acquisitions, may depend on our ability to raise capital by selling equity securities or obtaining additional debt financing. We cannot assure you, however, that we will be able to obtain financing when we need it or on terms acceptable to us. If we cannot, we may have to curtail our planned growth and not pursue acquisition opportunities.

 

We may not manage our growth effectively, and our profitability may suffer.

 

We have experienced rapid growth in recent years. This rapid expansion of our business may strain our management team, human resources and information systems. Despite our recent growth, we plan to continue

 

10


Table of Contents

evaluating opportunities to acquire other businesses and expanding our business rapidly. We cannot assure you, however, that we can successfully manage the integration of any businesses we may acquire or that they will result in the financial, operational and other benefits that we anticipate. To manage our growth successfully, we may need to add qualified managers and employees and periodically update our operating, financial and other systems, as well as our internal procedures and controls. We also must effectively motivate, train and manage a larger professional staff. If we fail to manage our growth effectively, our business, results of operations and financial condition may be harmed.

 

We operate with a substantial amount of debt, with variable interest rates.

 

Our total long-term debt at December 31, 2002, was approximately $97.8 million. We expect to repay $40.1 million of this debt with the proceeds of this offering as described in the section of this prospectus entitled “Use of Proceeds.” However, we still will have a substantial amount of debt following this offering. Operating with a high amount of leverage could require us to redirect a substantial portion of our cash flow from operations to make payments on our debt. This would reduce the funds available for operations, future business opportunities, capital expenditures, acquisitions and other purposes. It will also limit our flexibility in planning for, or reacting to, changes in our business and our industry. The terms of our debt also require us to meet specified financial covenants. If we fail either to meet these financial requirements or our lenders do not waive them, we will be required to pay fees and penalties. Our lenders could also accelerate the maturity of our debt if we fail to meet these covenants, which would force us to seek alternative financing. If this were to happen, we cannot assure you that we would be able to obtain the additional financing we may need or that it would be on terms favorable to us.

 

Our debt accrues interest at a variable rate. We have historically reduced our exposure to rising interest rates by entering into interest rate swaps. These historical hedge arrangements may result in us incurring higher interest expenses than we would have incurred without the hedges in place. We could also face the same problem if we were to decide to once again enter into new hedge arrangements. Although a few of these historical hedge arrangements will remain in place on our existing debt, we do not intend to enter into new hedge arrangements for the credit facility we put in place to finance our acquisition of BRS. If interest rates increase, we will need to dedicate more of our cash flow from operations to make payments on our debt. For more information on our liquidity, see “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations—Liquidity and Capital Resources.”

 

Our revenues, operating income and cash flows are likely to fluctuate.

 

We have experienced fluctuating revenues, operating income and cash flow in some prior periods and expect that this may occur from time to time in the future. We may experience future fluctuations in our annual or quarterly revenues and operating income because of the timing of our client assignments, the types of assignments we are working on at different times, hiring trends and decreased productivity because of vacations taken by our professionals. This means our profitability will likely decline if we experience an unexpected variation in the number or timing of client assignments or during the third quarter when substantial numbers of professionals take vacations, which reduces their utilization rates. We may also experience future fluctuations in our cash flows because of the timing of the payment of incentive compensation to our professionals, which we generally pay during the first quarter of each year. Also, the timing of any future acquisitions and the cost of integrating them may cause fluctuations in our operating results.

 

If our goodwill and other intangible assets become impaired, we will be required to write down their carrying value and incur a charge against income.

 

At September 30, 2002, our goodwill and other intangible assets from continuing operations, net of accumulated amortization, was approximately $323.0 million. We acquired all of our goodwill and other intangible assets in our acquisitions, including the approximately $243.7 million of goodwill and other intangible assets we have recorded from our purchase of BRS. At least once every year, we review whether these assets

 

11


Table of Contents

have been impaired. If these assets become impaired, we would be required to write down their carrying value and to incur charges against our income equal to the amount of the writedown. In addition, if we sell our applied sciences practice group for less than its carrying value, we would be required to take a charge against our income equal to the difference between the carrying value and the sale price. These charges would decrease our reported net income in the period in which we take them, which could cause the price of our common stock to decline.

 

Risks Related to Our Acquisition of BRS

 

A significant portion of BRS’ revenues results from relationships with clients and industry professionals maintained by a small number of our key professionals. The loss of one or more of these key professionals could decrease our revenues and our profitability.

 

The success of our acquisition of BRS will depend upon our retention of key partners from BRS as our senior managing directors. These key senior managing directors have reputations in the financial services industry for highly specialized skills as well as important relationships with existing clients and industry professionals. Their reputations and relationships are critical to gaining new client engagements, particularly large, complex matters. Our employment agreements with the former BRS partners provide them with various financial incentives to work for us during the four-year employment period. However, they are not obligated to remain with us for all four years or for any other length of time. The loss of one or more of these key senior managing directors could harm the success of our acquisition of BRS.

 

We cannot assure you that we can successfully integrate BRS into our business.

 

We completed the acquisition of BRS on August 30, 2002. The BRS acquisition was substantial for us in several respects, including its potential contribution to our results of operations and the addition of a significant number of professionals and client relationships. We have not previously undertaken an integration process as large as that required by the BRS acquisition. We cannot assure you that we will realize the potential financial, operating or other benefits that we expect from this acquisition. Integrating BRS into our business will require a significant amount of our resources and management time to coordinate our operations and personnel with those of BRS. The process of integrating BRS into our existing operations may result in unforeseen operating difficulties and may require significant financial, operational and managerial resources that would otherwise be available for the operation, development and expansion of our existing business. To the extent that we have miscalculated our ability to integrate and properly manage BRS, we may have difficulty in achieving our operating and strategic objectives.

 

We have a different system of governance and management from PwC, which could cause some of our key personnel to leave us.

 

When BRS was a division of PwC, we believe BRS shared many of the management practices and policies that PwC developed to manage its multinational network of firms. We believe our management practices and policies differ from PwC’s. During the transition period while we integrate BRS into our business, it is possible that these different management practices and policies may lead to workplace dissatisfaction on the part of the BRS professionals with our way of conducting business. This may cause some of our key professionals to leave us. The loss of one or more key professionals may harm our business and results of operations.

 

The benefits BRS enjoyed when it was part of PwC will no longer be available and this could harm the profitability of BRS.

 

BRS benefited from the name recognition and reputation of PwC and received referrals from other practices within PwC. Now that BRS is separate from PwC, BRS only has a limited ability to market its services by referring to the PwC name. Existing and potential clients and industry professionals may not recognize the new brand under which the professionals of BRS now provide their services. Consequently, we may need to incur substantial

 

12


Table of Contents

marketing expenses to strengthen and develop our brand, which could lower our profits below the levels BRS was historically able to generate. In addition, PwC has no incentive to refer clients to us, especially since PwC may continue to provide a limited amount of the sort of restructuring services performed by BRS. For information on our noncompetition arrangement with PwC, see “Business—Our Acquisition of BRS.” The loss of client referrals may harm our expected revenue growth and results of operations and cause the actual profitability of the acquired business to differ materially from our expectations and the expectations of the investing public. A failure to meet these expectations could cause the price our stock to decline.

 

Conflicts of interest may prevent us from providing services to new and existing clients, which could harm our revenues and results of operations.

 

Under conflict of interests rules, we generally may not represent both a debtor and its creditors on the same engagement. Accordingly, FTI and BRS together may not be able to accept all the engagements we could have previously accepted as separate entities. Although we have identified six client engagements that have created actual conflicts of interests as a result of our acquisition of BRS, only one of these engagements is a significant engagement for BRS. However, future conflicts of interest may require us to decline new client engagements. Our inability to accept new client engagements as a result of conflicts of interest may harm our revenue growth and results of operations.

 

Risks Related to the Offering and Ownership of Our Common Stock

 

If we or our stockholders sell substantial amounts of our common stock after the offering, the market price of our common stock may decline.

 

Sales of substantial amounts of our common stock in the public market following this offering, or the appearance that a large number of shares are available for sale, may adversely affect the market price of our common stock. After this offering, we will have 26,210,980 shares of common stock outstanding. Of these shares, 23,164,530 shares, including all shares sold in this offering, will be freely tradable under the Securities Act, unless acquired by one of our “affiliates,” as that term is defined in Rule 144 under the Securities Act. The remaining 3,046,450 shares will be subject to the restrictions of Rule 144. Of these remaining shares, 2,507,545 may be sold under Rule 144 on or after September 1, 2003, subject to volume and other restrictions, and because of contract restrictions, 235,243 of these shares may not be sold before September 1, 2004 and 235,243 of these shares may not be sold before September 1, 2006. Currently, approximately 863,768 shares of our common stock are subject to demand and piggyback registration rights. At January 10, 2003, we had reserved for issuance an additional 3,784,726 shares of common stock issuable upon exercise of outstanding stock options (at exercise prices ranging from $2.38 to $45.75 per share). All of the shares of common stock issuable upon the exercise of stock options will be freely tradable upon issuance as such shares are registered under a registration statement filed under the Securities Act. All of our executive officers, except Glenn R. Baker, and all of our directors and each selling stockholder have agreed with the underwriters not to sell or otherwise dispose of any of their shares for 90 days after the date of this prospectus without the prior written consent of Lehman Brothers. Our executive officers and directors, however, may sell or otherwise dispose of an aggregate of 200,000 of their shares without the prior written consent of Lehman Brothers if the closing sale price of our common stock exceeds 110% of the offering price specified on the front cover page of this prospectus on any trading date at least 30 days after the date of this prospectus. As of the date of this prospectus, these individuals beneficially own an aggregate of 657,201 shares of our common stock. Mr. Baker, President of our applied sciences practice group, beneficially owns options exercisable for 7,500 shares of our common stock.

 

We may raise additional capital in the future through equity financings, which will dilute your ownership in us and may cause the market price of our common stock to decline.

 

We may need to raise funds through additional public or private equity or debt financings in order to:

 

    fund working capital needs;

 

13


Table of Contents

 

    acquire additional businesses;

 

    expand our business into new regions or countries;

 

    introduce new service offerings and develop existing service offerings; or

 

    respond to competitive pressures.

 

Any additional capital raised through the sale of equity will dilute your percentage ownership in us and may decrease the market price of our common stock. We cannot assure you, however, that we will be able to raise equity or obtain debt financing when we need it, if at all, or on terms acceptable to us. In addition, our agreement with the underwriters of this offering prohibits us generally from offering or selling shares of our common stock, or securities convertible into or exchangeable into our common stock, for 90 days from the date of this prospectus without the prior consent of Lehman Brothers.

 

14


Table of Contents

USE OF PROCEEDS

 

We expect to receive about $80.3 million of net proceeds from the sale of the 2,100,000 shares of our common stock that we are offering by this prospectus, at an assumed public offering price of $40.96 per share (after deducting underwriting discounts and commissions and estimated offering expenses). We will not receive any proceeds from the sale of shares of common stock by the selling stockholders.

 

At September 30, 2002, we owed approximately $138.9 million under our credit facility. We used borrowings from our credit facility, as well as some of our existing cash, to purchase BRS.

 

Under the provisions of our credit facility, we must apply at least half of the net proceeds that we obtain from a public offering of our equity securities to repay our borrowings under the facility. We intend to use the net proceeds we receive from this offering to repay $80.3 million of our debt under our credit facility. We intend to use half of these net proceeds to repay a portion of the $74.0 million term loan under our credit facility and the remainder to repay amounts outstanding, if any under the revolving credit loan under our credit facility. As of December 31, 2002, no amounts were outstanding under our revolving credit facility. Any proceeds available to us after these repayments will be used for general corporate purposes. Bank of America, N.A. and SunTrust Bank, as lenders under our credit facility, will receive their proportionate share of any repayment of debt from the net proceeds we receive from this offering. Each of these lenders is affiliated with an underwriter of this offering. For more information regarding these affiliations, see “Underwriting—Our Relationships with Underwriters.”

 

Debt under our credit facility bears interest at an annual rate equal to LIBOR plus an applicable margin or an alternative base rate defined as the higher of (1) the lender’s announced prime rate or (2) the federal funds rate plus the sum of 50 basis points and an applicable margin. At September 30, 2002, the interest rate under the credit facility was 4.95% per annum. If not prepaid, our $24.9 million term loan under our credit facility will mature on December 1, 2005, and our $74.0 million term loan under our credit facility will mature on August 30, 2006. We will not have any prepayment penalties for early payment of the debt under the credit facility. We discuss the provisions of our credit facility in “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations—Liquidity and Capital Resources.”

 

15


Table of Contents

PRICE RANGE OF COMMON STOCK AND DIVIDEND POLICY

 

Our common stock has been listed on the New York Stock Exchange under the symbol “FCN” since August 16, 2001. Prior to that date, our common stock was listed on the American Stock Exchange under the same symbol. The following table shows the high and low closing prices per share for our common stock for the periods shown, as reported by the New York Stock Exchange or the American Stock Exchange, as applicable. These prices have been adjusted to give effect to the three-for-two stock split we paid as a stock dividend to our stockholders of record on January 2, 2002.

 

    

High


  

Low


2001

             

First Quarter

  

$

  8.67

  

$

  5.67

Second Quarter

  

 

14.53

  

 

8.67

Third Quarter

  

 

19.60

  

 

12.83

Fourth Quarter

  

 

22.73

  

 

18.40

2002

             

First Quarter

  

 

32.26

  

 

21.47

Second Quarter

  

 

36.30

  

 

29.90

Third Quarter

  

 

41.95

  

 

29.01

Fourth Quarter

  

 

42.88

  

 

32.75

2003

             

First Quarter (through February 5, 2003)

  

 

43.25

  

 

38.87

 

At January 29, 2003, there were about 151 holders of record of our common stock.

 

We have never paid cash dividends on our common stock, and we do not intend to pay dividends in the foreseeable future. Our existing credit facility limits our ability to pay cash dividends. We expect to retain any future profits to repay existing debt and finance our operations for the foreseeable future.

 

16


Table of Contents

CAPITALIZATION

 

The following table shows our cash and cash equivalents and capitalization at September 30, 2002:

 

    on an actual basis; and

 

    on an as adjusted basis to give effect to the:

 

    receipt of the estimated net proceeds from the sale of 2,100,000 shares of our common stock by us in this offering, after deducting estimated underwriting commissions and offering expenses; and

 

    assumed retirement of $80.3 million of our debt under our credit facility with the proceeds from this offering.

 

You should also refer to our historical consolidated financial statements and our unaudited pro forma consolidated statements of income, which we have included elsewhere in this prospectus.

 

    

At September 30, 2002


 
    

Actual


    

As Adjusted


 
    

(in thousands, except share amounts)

 

Cash and cash equivalents

  

$

3,618

 

  

$

3,618

 

    


  


Total debt

  

$

138,916

 

  

$

58,631

 

Less current portion

  

 

16,083

 

  

 

16,083

 

    


  


Total long-term debt

  

 

122,833

 

  

 

42,548

 

    


  


Stockholders’ equity:

                 

Preferred stock, $0.01 par value, 5,000,000 shares authorized, no shares issued or outstanding, actual and as adjusted

  

 

—  

 

  

 

—  

 

Common stock, $0.01 par value, 45,000,000 shares authorized, 23,713,055 shares issued and outstanding, actual and 25,813,055 shares issued and outstanding, as adjusted

  

 

237

 

  

 

258

 

Additional paid-in capital

  

 

193,997

 

  

 

274,261

 

Unearned compensation

  

 

(411

)

  

 

(411

)

Retained earnings

  

 

53,220

 

  

 

53,220

 

Accumulated other comprehensive loss

  

 

(838

)

  

 

(838

)

    


  


Total stockholders’ equity

  

 

246,205

 

  

 

326,490

 

    


  


Total capitalization

  

$

385,121

 

  

$

385,121

 

    


  


 

The table above excludes 3,651,714 shares of our common stock issuable upon the exercise of stock options outstanding under our stock option plans with a weighted average exercise price of $18.69 per share at September 30, 2002.

 

17


Table of Contents

UNAUDITED PRO FORMA CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF INCOME

 

On August 30, 2002, we acquired BRS for $141.3 million in cash and 3,000,000 shares of our common stock, valued at $101.9 million. We borrowed $119.0 million on August 30, 2002 to pay part of the cash consideration for the BRS acquisition.

 

The purchase price includes the cash paid at closing, plus the fair market value of our common stock that we delivered to PwC and estimated acquisition-related costs. The purchase price is summarized as follows (in thousands):

 

Cash

  

$

140,220

Fair value of common stock

  

 

101,880

Estimated transaction costs

  

 

1,114

    

    

$

243,214

    

 

The 3,000,000 shares of common stock issued for BRS were valued using the average stock price of FTI for the five day period beginning two days before and ending two days after July 24, 2002, which was the date the transaction was announced. This resulted in an average stock price of $33.96 per share.

 

The fair values of the acquired BRS assets and liabilities were estimated for the purpose of allocating the purchase price at the acquisition date. The purchase price of $243.2 million has been assigned to the tangible and intangible assets acquired and liabilities assumed as follows (in thousands):

 

Current assets at August 30, 2002

  

$

26,892

 

Fair value adjustments:

        

Identified intangible assets

  

 

5,100

 

Goodwill

  

 

238,572

 

    


    

 

270,564

 

Less liabilities assumed at August 30, 2002

  

 

(27,350

)

    


    

$

243,214

 

    


 

The accompanying unaudited pro forma consolidated statements of income for the year ended December 31, 2001 and the nine months ended September 30, 2002 give effect to the acquisition of BRS, including the assumed effects of the debt financing transactions related to the acquisition, as if the acquisition had occurred on January 1, 2001. BRS operated under a fiscal year ending June 30. The accompanying pro forma consolidated statements of income for both the annual and nine-month period presented have been prepared after adjusting BRS’ accounting period to conform to our year end of December 31.

 

The pro forma adjustments are described in the accompanying notes and are based upon available information and various assumptions that management believes are reasonable. These adjustments give effect to events directly attributable to the transactions and do not reflect any restructuring or integration costs, or any potential cost savings or other synergies that management expects to realize as a result of the transaction. The unaudited pro forma consolidated statements of income do not purport to represent what our results of operations would have actually been had the acquisition occurred on January 1, 2001. The unaudited pro forma consolidated statements of income should be read in conjunction with our historical consolidated financial statements and the historical financial statements of BRS, which are included elsewhere in this prospectus and together with “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations.”

 

18


Table of Contents

Unaudited Pro Forma Consolidated Statements of Income

 

    

Year ended December 31, 2001


 
    

Historical

FTI


    

BRS


    

Pro Forma

Adjustments


    

Total


 
    

(in thousands, except per share data)

 

Revenues

  

$

122,317

 

  

$

170,689

 

  

$

(3,445

)

 

(b

)

  

$

289,561

 

Direct cost of revenues

  

 

59,074

 

  

 

80,840

(1)

  

 

 

 

28,895

(1,721

(937

 

)

)

 

(c

(d

(e

)

)

)

  

 

166,151

 

Selling, general and administrative expenses

  

 

33,085

 

  

 

30,828

 

  

 

(10,629

)

 

(f

)

  

 

53,284

 

Amortization expense (a)

  

 

4,235

 

  

 

—  

 

  

 

3,400

 

 

(g

)

  

 

7,635

 

    


  


  


        


Total costs and expenses

  

 

96,394

 

  

 

111,668

 

  

 

19,008

 

        

 

227,070

 

    


  


  


        


Operating income

  

 

25,923

 

  

 

59,021

 

  

 

(22,453

)

        

 

62,491

 

Interest expense, net

  

 

(4,356

)

  

 

(912

)

  

 

(5,749

)

 

(h

)

  

 

(11,017

)

    


  


  


        


Income from continuing operations before
income taxes

  

 

21,567

 

  

 

58,109

 

  

 

(28,202

)

        

 

51,474

 

Income taxes

  

 

8,621

 

  

 

—  

 

  

 

11,963

 

 

(i

)

  

 

20,584

 

    


  


  


        


Income from continuing operations

  

$

12,946

 

  

$

58,109

 

  

$

(40,165

)

        

$

30,890

 

    


  


  


        


Earnings per common share from continuing operations:

                                         

Basic

  

$

0.72

 

                          

$

1.48

 

    


                          


Diluted

  

$

0.66

 

                          

$

1.36

 

    


                          


Weighted average shares outstanding, basic

  

 

17,841

 

           

 

3,000

 

 

(j

)

  

 

20,841

 

    


           


        


Weighted average shares outstanding, diluted

  

 

19,631

 

           

 

3,000

 

 

(j

)

  

 

22,631

 

    


           


        


    

Nine months ended September 30, 2002


 
    

Historical

FTI


    

BRS(2)


    

Pro Forma

Adjustments


    

Total


 
    

(in thousands, except per share data)

 

Revenues

  

$

133,556

 

  

$

113,284

 

  

$

(4,263

)

 

(b

)

  

$

242,577

 

Direct cost of revenues

  

 

65,512

 

  

 

49,669

(1)

  

 

 

 

21,050

(2,218)

(765)

 

 

 

 

(c

(d

(e

)

)

)

  

 

133,248

 

Selling, general and administrative expenses

  

 

32,796

 

  

 

23,662

 

  

 

(6,338

)

 

(f

)

  

 

50,120

 

Amortization expense (a)

  

 

252

 

  

 

—  

 

  

 

2,267

 

 

(g

)

  

 

2,519

 

    


  


  


        


Total costs and expenses

  

 

98,560

 

  

 

73,331

 

  

 

13,996

 

        

 

185,887

 

    


  


  


        


Operating income

  

 

34,996

 

  

 

39,953

 

  

 

(18,259

)

        

 

56,690

 

Interest expense, net

  

 

(2,582

)

  

 

(154

)

  

 

(3,831

)

 

(h

)

  

 

(6,567

)

    


  


  


        


Income from continuing operations before
income taxes

  

 

32,414

 

  

 

39,799

 

  

 

(22,090

)

        

 

50,123

 

Income taxes

  

 

13,021

 

  

 

—  

 

  

 

7,084

 

 

(i

)

  

 

20,105

 

    


  


  


        


Income from continuing operations

  

$

19,393

 

  

$

39,799

 

  

$

(29,174

)

        

$

30,018

 

    


  


  


        


Earnings per common share from continuing operations:

                                         

Basic

  

$

0.94

 

                          

$

1.29

 

    


                          


Diluted

  

$

0.88

 

                          

$

1.22

 

    


                          


Weighted average shares outstanding, basic

  

 

20,534

 

           

 

2,648

 

 

(j

)

  

 

23,182

 

    


           


        


Weighted average shares outstanding, diluted

  

 

22,011

 

           

 

2,648

 

 

(j

)

  

 

24,659

 

    


           


        


 

(1)

The historical financial statements of BRS include direct cost of revenues based on the cost sharing arrangements that existed between BRS and other PwC business units. These cost sharing arrangements provided that, for all non-BRS personnel assigned to BRS engagements from other PwC business units, BRS would be charged for costs in an amount equal to the revenue generated from the services of the

 

19


Table of Contents
 

imported personnel. Accordingly, included in the historical and the pro forma consolidated statements of income for the year ended December 31, 2001 and the nine months ended September 30, 2002 are BRS revenues of $20.9 million and $9.8 million, respectively, without any associated gross margin because an equal amount of direct cost of revenues was also recorded. These cost sharing arrangements with PwC have been terminated as a result of the acquisition. FTI expects that all post-acquisition BRS engagements will be staffed internally and therefore believes that the lack of any gross margins reported in the accompanying pro forma statements of income is not indicative of the gross margins that FTI will achieve from the acquired business subsequent to the acquisition. If the cost sharing agreements between PwC and BRS for imported personnel were based on the costs incurred by FTI, FTI believes that the costs in 2001 would have been approximately $10.0 million lower than the reported amount of $20.9 million. For the nine months ended September 30, 2002, FTI believes that BRS-related costs would have been approximately $5.1 million lower than the reported amount of $9.8 million. See Note (2) below.

 

(2) Represents operating results of BRS for the eight months ended August 30, 2002. The results of operations for BRS in September 2002 are included in FTI’s historical results.

 

NOTES TO UNAUDITED PRO FORMA CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF INCOME

 

Adjustments to the unaudited pro forma consolidated statements of income for the year ended December 31, 2001 and the nine-month period ended September 30, 2002 in connection with the BRS acquisition are presented below:

 

(a) As of January 1, 2002, we adopted Financial Accounting Standards Board Statement No. 142, Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets (“Statement 142”). Under the new rules, goodwill and other intangible assets deemed to have indefinite lives are no longer amortized but are subject to impairment tests at least annually. Other intangible assets with finite lives continue to be amortized over their useful lives.

 

In accordance with Statement 142, we are no longer amortizing the $94.0 million of goodwill recorded at December 31, 2001. The goodwill amortization expense for the year ended December 31, 2001 was $5.0 million. All of the pro forma amortization expense recorded for the nine-month period ended September 30, 2002 was attributable to the estimated fair value of other intangible assets with finite lives that were recorded in connection with the BRS acquisition.

 

(b) Adjustment to eliminate the portion of billable revenues of BRS partners and staff working on non-BRS related engagements. Because BRS was a division of a large, multi-disciplined business, BRS partners and staff could be assigned to non-BRS engagements. The historical financial statements include all revenues generated by BRS partners and staff regardless of the nature of the engagement. This adjustment adjusts revenues to the amounts generated from the business acquired and eliminates revenue generated from assisting other PwC divisions. FTI will not generate any revenues in the future from assisting other PwC divisions.

 

(c) Adjustment to record pro forma compensation expense, including retirement and other benefits, for the former partners of BRS. Historically, the BRS statement of income excluded payments for partner distribution and profits because partners did not receive salaries as compensation for services, but rather received earnings distributions recorded as a reduction of net assets. In connection with the acquisition of BRS, we entered into employment contracts with 49 former partners of BRS that provide for the payment of salaries consistent with the amounts received in BRS’ fiscal year 2002 as earnings distributions. The pro forma adjustment, consistent with the employment contracts, assumes that earnings distributions to partners for each respective period were expensed as compensation. The component of the pro forma adjustment related to benefits is $1.5 million and $1.0 million for the year ended December 31, 2001 and the nine months ended September 30, 2002, respectively. These benefit costs are medical, dental insurance, 401(k), and payroll taxes, all of which are based on estimated costs that would have been incurred had these benefits been in place during the historical periods.

 

20


Table of Contents

 

(d) Adjustment to eliminate the direct costs, such as partner and staff salaries, related to eliminated revenues generated by BRS partners and staff assigned to non-BRS engagements, as discussed above in Note (b). These costs were directly related to PwC’s ownership of BRS and will not be incurred on an on-going basis.

 

(e) Adjustment to reduce direct costs for pension expense eliminated in the BRS acquisition. Employee benefit compensation expense under the former PwC defined benefit and contribution plans for the year ended December 31, 2001 and eight-month period ended August 30, 2002 was $1.3 million and $1.0 million, respectively. Under the FTI defined contribution plan, employee benefit compensation expense related to BRS personnel for the year ended December 31, 2001 and nine months ended September 30, 2002 would have been $401,000 and $268,000, respectively.

 

(f) Adjustment to eliminate certain non-recurring selling, general and administrative costs allocated to BRS by PwC. The BRS business has historically operated on a stand alone basis and has separately incurred and recorded technology services, human resources, finance and accounting and marketing and business development costs. The historical financial statements of BRS also include a charge for firm-wide management, technology services, human resources, finance and accounting and marketing and business development costs based on an allocation methodology. Because some of these allocated costs fully duplicate costs incurred on a stand-alone basis, we have made a pro forma adjustment to eliminate such duplicated, allocated overhead costs.

 

(g) Adjustment to record pro forma amortization expense for the $5.1 million of other intangible assets recorded upon the acquisition of BRS. These intangible assets consist principally of engagement backlog, intellectual property and non-competition agreements. These assets will be amortized over their estimated useful lives. The weighted-average estimated useful life of these acquired intangible assets is 18 months.

 

(h) Adjustment to record pro forma interest expense. In connection with the acquisition of BRS, we incurred $3.7 million of financing costs that are being amortized over the average contractual life of the related debt of four years. In addition, we borrowed $119.0 million to pay the cash portion of the acquisition cost. Based on the LIBOR rate in effect at the closing date, the average interest rate associated with the acquisition related borrowings was 4.3% at the closing date of August 30, 2002.

 

(i) Adjustment to record the pro forma income tax expense for (i) the operations of BRS for which no taxes were provided in the historical financial statements because BRS was a component of a partnership, and (ii) the estimated tax effects of pro forma adjustments, all at the combined federal and state statutory income tax rate of approximately 40%.

 

(j) Adjustment to increase the weighted-average shares outstanding for the 3,000,000 shares that we issued upon the acquisition of BRS.

 

21


Table of Contents

 

Unaudited Pro Forma Statements of Income for BRS as a Stand Alone Company

 

The following unaudited pro forma statements of income are based on the historical financial statements of BRS for the periods presented, adjusted to present BRS as a company separate from PwC. The pro forma adjustments are described in the notes above and are based upon available information and assumptions that management believes are reasonable.

 

    

Year ended December 31, 2001


    

Eight months ended August 30, 2002


 
    

BRS


    

Pro Forma

Adjustments


    

Pro Forma

As Adjusted


    

BRS


    

Pro Forma

Adjustments


    

Pro Forma

As Adjusted


 
    

(in thousands)

 

Revenues

  

$

170,689

 

  

$

(3,445

)(b)

  

$

167,244

 

  

$

113,284

 

  

$

(4,263

)(b)

  

$

109,021

 

Direct cost of revenues(*)

  

 

80,840

 

  

 

28,895

 (c)

  

 

107,077

 

  

 

49,669

 

  

 

21,050

 (c)

  

 

67,736

 

             

 

(1,721

)(d)

                    

 

(2,218

)(d)

        
             

 

(937

)(e)

                    

 

(765

)(e)

        

Selling, general and administrative expenses

  

 

30,828

 

  

 

(10,629

)(f)

  

 

20,199

 

  

 

23,662

 

  

 

(6,338

)(f)

  

 

17,324

 

    


  


  


  


  


  


Total costs and expenses

  

 

111,668

 

  

 

15,608

 

  

 

127,276

 

  

 

73,331

 

  

 

11,729

 

  

 

85,060

 

    


  


  


  


  


  


Income from operations

  

 

59,021

 

  

 

(19,053

)

  

 

39,968

 

  

 

39,953

 

  

 

(15,992

)

  

 

23,961

 

Interest expense, net

  

 

(912

)

  

 

—  

 

  

 

(912

)

  

 

(154

)

  

 

—  

 

  

 

(154

)

    


  


  


  


  


  


Income from operations
before income taxes

  

 

58,109

 

  

 

(19,053

)

  

 

39,056

 

  

 

39,799

 

  

 

(15,992

)

  

 

23,807

 

Income taxes

  

 

—  

 

  

 

15,622

 (i)

  

 

15,622

 

  

 

—  

 

  

 

9,523

 (i)

  

 

9,523

 

    


  


  


  


  


  


Income from continuing operations

  

$

58,109

 

  

$

(34,675

)

  

$

23,434

 

  

$

39,799

 

  

$

(25,515

)

  

$

14,284

 

    


  


  


  


  


  


 

(*) The historical financial statements of BRS include direct cost of revenues based on the cost sharing arrangements that existed between BRS and other PwC business units. These cost sharing arrangements provided that, for all non-BRS personnel assigned to BRS engagements from other PwC business units, BRS would be charged for costs in an amount equal to the revenue generated from the services of the imported personnel. Accordingly, included in the historical and the pro forma statements of income for BRS for the year ended December 31, 2001 and the eight months ended August 30, 2002 are BRS revenues of $20.9 million and $9.8 million, respectively, without any associated gross margin because an equal amount of direct cost of revenues was recorded. These cost sharing arrangements with PwC have been terminated as a result of the acquisition. FTI expects that all post-acquisition BRS engagements will be staffed internally and therefore believes that the lack of any gross margins reported in the accompanying pro forma statements of income is not indicative of the gross margins that FTI will achieve from the acquired business subsequent to the acquisition. If the cost sharing agreements between PwC and BRS for imported personnel were based on the costs incurred by FTI, FTI believes that the costs in 2001 would have been approximately $10.0 million lower than the reported amount of $20.9 million. For the eight months ended August 30, 2002, FTI believes that costs would have been approximately $5.1 million lower than the reported amount of $9.8 million.

 

22


Table of Contents

SELECTED FINANCIAL DATA

 

The selected historical consolidated financial data for FTI at December 31, 2000 and 2001 and for the three years ended December 31, 2001 have been derived from FTI’s audited consolidated financial statements previously filed with the SEC and included elsewhere in this prospectus. The selected historical consolidated balance sheet data of FTI at December 31, 1997, 1998 and 1999 and the selected historical consolidated statement of income data of FTI for the years ended December 31, 1997 and 1998 have been derived from FTI’s audited consolidated financial statements previously filed with the SEC but not included in this prospectus. FTI’s selected unaudited interim financial data included in this prospectus was derived from its books and records and, in the opinion of management, contain all adjustments, consisting only of normal recurring adjustments, necessary for the fair presentation of its financial position and results of operations at and for such periods. The results of operations for any interim period are not necessarily indicative of the results of operations to be expected for the full year.

 

The selected historical financial data for BRS at June 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002 and for the three fiscal years then ended have been derived from BRS’ audited financial statements included in this prospectus.

 

When you read this selected financial data it is important that you read along with it the historical financial statements and related notes included elsewhere in this prospectus as well as “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations.”

 

Selected Historical Consolidated Financial Data of FTI

 

    

Year ended December 31,


    

Nine months ended

September 30,


 
    

1997(1)


    

1998(2)


    

1999


    

2000(3)


    

2001


    

2001


    

2002(4)


 
    

(in thousands, except percentages and per share data)

 

Statement of Income Data:

                                                              

Revenues

  

$

32,175

 

  

$

35,771

 

  

$

48,914

 

  

$

95,532

 

  

$

122,317

 

  

$

91,826

 

  

$

133,556

 

Direct cost of revenues

  

 

17,537

 

  

 

19,752

 

  

 

25,600

 

  

 

48,979

 

  

 

59,074

 

  

 

46,704

 

  

 

65,512

 

Selling, general and administrative expenses

  

 

12,604

 

  

 

12,895

 

  

 

16,532

 

  

 

23,920

 

  

 

33,085

 

  

 

23,608

 

  

 

32,796

 

Amortization of goodwill and other intangible assets

  

 

59

 

  

 

681

 

  

 

1,554

 

  

 

3,942

 

  

 

4,235

 

  

 

3,156

 

  

 

252

 

    


  


  


  


  


  


  


Total costs and expenses

  

 

30,200

 

  

 

33,328

 

  

 

43,686

 

  

 

76,841

 

  

 

96,394

 

  

 

73,468

 

  

 

98,560

 

    


  


  


  


  


  


  


Operating income

  

 

1,975

 

  

 

2,443

 

  

 

5,228

 

  

 

18,691

 

  

 

25,923

 

  

 

18,358

 

  

 

34,996

 

Interest income (expense), net

  

 

173

 

  

 

(1,163

)

  

 

(4,014

)

  

 

(10,771

)

  

 

(4,356

)

  

 

(3,533

)

  

 

(2,582

)

    


  


  


  


  


  


  


Income from continuing operations before income taxes and extraordinary item

  

 

2,148

 

  

 

1,280

 

  

 

1,214

 

  

 

7,920

 

  

 

21,567

 

  

 

14,825

 

  

 

32,414

 

Income taxes

  

 

899

 

  

 

583

 

  

 

402

 

  

 

3,262

 

  

 

8,621

 

  

 

6,148

 

  

 

13,021

 

    


  


  


  


  


  


  


Income from continuing operations before extraordinary item

  

$

1,249

 

  

$

697

 

  

$

812

 

  

$

4,658

 

  

$

12,946

 

  

$

8,677

 

  

$

19,393

 

    


  


  


  


  


  


  


Net income

  

$

3,293

 

  

$

2,568

 

  

$

2,991

 

  

$

2,561

 

  

$

16,469

 

  

$

11,633

 

  

$

22,184

 

    


  


  


  


  


  


  


Income from continuing operations before extraordinary item per common share:

                                                              

Basic

  

$

0.18

 

  

$

0.10

 

  

$

0.11

 

  

$

0.44

 

  

$

0.72

 

  

$

0.50

 

  

$

0.94

 

    


  


  


  


  


  


  


Diluted

  

$

0.18

 

  

$

0.09

 

  

$

0.11

 

  

$

0.39

 

  

$

0.66

 

  

$

0.45

 

  

$

0.88

 

    


  


  


  


  


  


  


Weighted average shares outstanding,

                                                              

Basic

  

 

6,794

 

  

 

7,088

 

  

 

7,308

 

  

 

10,612

 

  

 

17,841

 

  

 

17,318

 

  

 

20,534

 

    


  


  


  


  


  


  


Weighted average shares outstanding,

                                                              

Diluted

  

 

7,047

 

  

 

7,615

 

  

 

7,543

 

  

 

11,988

 

  

 

19,631

 

  

 

19,229

 

  

 

22,011

 

    


  


  


  


  


  


  


Other Data:

                                                              

Capital expenditures

  

$

2,800

 

  

$

3,327

 

  

$

3,093

 

  

$

6,640

 

  

$

4,366

 

  

$

2,485

 

  

$

5,949

 

    


  


  


  


  


  


  


EBITDA (5)

  

$

4,349

 

  

$

4,753

 

  

$

8,595

 

  

$

24,865

 

  

$

33,399

 

  

$

23,851

 

  

$

38,404

 

    


  


  


  


  


  


  


EBITDA margin (6)

  

 

13.5

%

  

 

13.3

%

  

 

17.6

%

  

 

26.0

%

  

 

27.3

%

  

 

26.0

%

  

 

28.8

%

    


  


  


  


  


  


  


 

23


Table of Contents
    

At December 31,


  

At September 30,


    

1997


  

1998


  

1999


  

2000


  

2001


  

2001


  

2002


    

(in thousands)

Balance Sheet Data:

                                                

Cash and cash equivalents

  

$

2,456

  

$

3,223

  

$

5,046

  

$

3,235

  

$

12,856

  

$

2,820

  

$

3,618

Working capital

  

 

10,634

  

 

9,071

  

 

19,233

  

 

20,163

  

 

28,766

  

 

25,680

  

 

15,049

Total assets

  

 

29,176

  

 

80,280

  

 

84,840

  

 

149,246

  

 

159,098

  

 

151,823

  

 

447,015

Long-term debt

  

 

1,930

  

 

46,280

  

 

42,727

  

 

60,500

  

 

28,166

  

 

33,750

  

 

138,916

Total stockholders’ equity

  

 

21,019

  

 

25,594

  

 

30,252

  

 

68,624

  

 

105,136

  

 

97,147

  

 

246,205


(1) In September 1997, we acquired L.W.G., Inc. and subsidiary, and Bodaken & Associates in business combinations accounted for as purchases.
(2) In June 1998, we acquired Klick, Kent & Allen, Inc. In September 1998, we acquired S.E.A., Inc., Kahn Consulting, Inc. and KCI Management Corp. These business combinations were accounted for as purchases.
(3) Effective January 31, 2000, we acquired Policano & Manzo, L.L.C. in a business combination accounted for as a purchase.
(4) On August 30, 2002, we acquired BRS in a business combination accounted for as a purchase.
(5) EBITDA refers to earnings before taxes, net interest expense and depreciation and amortization. Because all companies do not calculate EBITDA or similarly titled financial measures in the same manner, other companies’ disclosures of EBITDA may not be comparable with EBITDA as we calculate it. EBITDA should not be considered as an alternative to net income or loss (as an indicator of operating performance) or as an alternative to cash flow (as a measure of liquidity or ability to service debt obligations) and is not a measure of performance or financial condition under generally accepted accounting principles. EBITDA is intended to provide additional information for evaluating the ability of an entity to meet its financial obligations.
(6) EBITDA margin equals EBITDA divided by our total revenues for each period presented, in percentage format.

 

24


Table of Contents

Selected Historical Financial Data of BRS

 

    

Fiscal year ended June 30,


    

2000


  

2001


  

2002


    

(in thousands, except per share data)

Statement of Income Data:

                    

Revenues

  

$

141,093

  

$

156,948

  

$

179,262

    

  

  

Cost of services (1)

  

 

60,744

  

 

64,943

  

 

64,642

Reimbursables and subcontractor costs

  

 

9,401

  

 

12,844

  

 

14,275

    

  

  

Total costs of services (1)

  

 

70,145

  

 

77,787

  

 

78,917

Selling, general and administrative expenses (1)

  

 

30,851

  

 

28,387

  

 

33,542

    

  

  

Operating income (1)

  

 

40,097

  

 

50,774

  

 

66,803

Interest expense and other

  

 

422

  

 

715

  

 

603

Other expense

  

 

364

  

 

605

  

 

584

    

  

  

Income before partner distributions and benefits (1)

  

$

39,311

  

$

49,454

  

$

65,616

    

  

  


(1) Excludes payments for partner distributions and benefits.

 

    

At June 30,


 
    

2000


  

2001


    

2002


 
    

(in thousands)

 

Balance Sheet Data:

                        

Working capital

  

$

2,266

  

$

(3,007

)

  

$

(19,932

)

Total assets

  

 

21,583

  

 

33,556

 

  

 

35,541

 

Total liabilities and PwC U.S. investment

  

 

21,583

  

 

33,556

 

  

 

35,541

 

 

25


Table of Contents

MANAGEMENT’S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL

CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS

 

The following discussion of our financial condition and results of operations should be read together with our consolidated financial statements and related notes included elsewhere in this prospectus. This discussion contains forward-looking statements that involve risks and uncertainties. Our actual results may differ materially from those anticipated in those forward-looking statements as a result of certain factors, including, but not limited to, those described under “Risk Factors” or in other portions of this prospectus.

 

Overview

 

We are one of the largest U.S. providers of turnaround, restructuring, bankruptcy and related consulting services. Our highly skilled professionals assist distressed companies in improving their financial position, or their creditors or other stakeholders in maximizing recovery of their claims. We also provide other consulting services such as corporate recovery, forensic accounting, fraud investigation and asset tracing, regulatory, intellectual property and mergers and acquisitions advisory services. Our trial support practice group advises clients in all phases of litigation, including pre-filing, discovery, jury selection, trial preparation, expert testimony and the actual trial.

 

Our direct cost of revenues consists primarily of employee compensation and related payroll benefits, the cost of outside consultants assigned to revenue-generating activities and other related expenses billable to clients. In 2001, our direct costs were 48.3% of revenues, consistent with our long-term 50.0% target and an improvement from 51.3% in 2000. For the nine months ended September 30, 2002, our direct costs were 49.1% of revenues, consistent with our overall long-term 50.0% target and with the corresponding nine months of 2001.

 

Selling, general and administrative expenses consist primarily of salaries and benefits paid to office and corporate staff, as well as rent, marketing, corporate overhead expenses and depreciation and amortization of property and equipment. In 2001, selling, general and administrative expenses, including depreciation and amortization of property and equipment, accounted for about 27.0% of our revenues, approximately the same as the 25.0% result in 2000. Our corporate overhead costs, which are included in selling, general and administrative expenses, represented about 6.3% of revenues in 2001 and 5.9% in 2000. For the nine months ended September 30, 2002, selling, general and administrative expenses, including depreciation and amortization of property and equipment, accounted for about 24.6% of our revenues, an improvement from the 25.7% experienced for the nine months ended September 30, 2001 and consistent with our long-term target of 25.0% excluding depreciation and amortization. Our corporate overhead costs, which are included in selling, general and administrative expenses, represented about 7.6% of revenues for the nine months ended September 30, 2002 and 7.8% in the same period of 2001.

 

We had goodwill related to our continuing operations of about $318.2 million at September 30, 2002 that we recorded principally from business combinations that we completed in the last five years, including $238.7 million related to our acquisition of BRS and $3.7 million related to our acquisition of TFC, both during 2002. This goodwill represented about 71.2% of our total assets at September 30, 2002. As of January 1, 2002, we no longer amortize this goodwill, but rather make annual assessments of impairment. Our applied sciences practice group had goodwill of approximately $14.4 million at September 30, 2002.

 

Recent Developments

 

Acquisition of BRS

 

On August 30, 2002, we acquired BRS for $141.3 million in cash and 3,000,000 shares of our common stock valued at $101.9 million. On a pro forma basis, as adjusted to present BRS as a company separate from PwC, BRS had revenues of $167.2 million and operating income of $40.0 million for the year ended December 31, 2001, and revenues of $109.0 million and operating income of $24.0 million for the eight-month period ended August 30, 2002.

 

26


Table of Contents

 

Pending Sale of Our Applied Sciences Practice Group

 

In July 2002, we committed to a plan to sell our applied sciences practice group, which we previously reported as a separate segment. The asset disposal group comprising the applied sciences practice group is available for immediate sale in its present condition, subject only to the terms that are usual and customary for sales of such asset disposal groups. An active program to locate a buyer, and other actions required to complete the plan to sell, have been initiated.

 

The sale of the entire asset disposal group is considered probable and is expected to be completed by the end of 2003. Actions necessary to complete the plan indicate that it is unlikely significant changes to the plan will be made or that the plan will be withdrawn.

 

The assets comprising the applied sciences asset disposal group are measured at the lower of their carrying amount or estimated fair value less cost to sell. Property and equipment held for sale with a carrying value of $1.6 million are no longer being depreciated. We currently expect to recover the carrying value of the assets of the disposal group, which was $28.6 million at September 30, 2002. However, it is reasonably possible that the ultimate amount realized from the sale may be less than the carrying value. Depending on the sale price and the tax structure of the transaction, the amount realized after taxes from the sale may be less than the carrying value.

 

Because the operations and cash flows of the applied sciences practice group will be eliminated from our ongoing operations as a result of the pending disposal transaction, and because we will not have any significant continuing involvement in the held for sale operations after the disposal transaction, the results of the applied sciences practice group’s operations are reported for all periods presented as a separate component of income, net of income taxes.

 

Critical Accounting Policies

 

General.    Our discussion and analysis of our financial condition and results of operations are based on our consolidated financial statements, which we have prepared in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the U.S. The preparation of these financial statements requires us to make estimates and judgments that affect the reported amounts of assets, liabilities, revenues and expenses, and related disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities. On an ongoing basis, we evaluate our estimates, including those related to bad debts, goodwill, income taxes and contingencies. We base our estimates on historical experience and on various other assumptions that we believe are reasonable under the circumstances, the results of which form the basis for making judgments about the carrying values of assets and liabilities that are not readily apparent from other sources. Actual results may differ from these estimates under different assumptions or conditions.

 

We believe that the following critical accounting policies affect our more significant judgments and estimates used in the preparation of our consolidated financial statements.

 

Revenue Recognition.    We derive substantially all of our revenue from providing professional services to our clients. Most of these services are rendered under arrangements that require the client to pay us a fee for the hours that we incur at agreed-upon rates. We also bill our clients for the cost of the production of our work products and other direct expenses that we incur on behalf of the client, such as travel costs and materials that we purchase to produce presentations for courtroom proceedings. We recognize our revenue from professional services as work is performed and expenses are incurred. The basis for our policy is the fact that we normally obtain engagement letters or other agreements from our clients prior to performing any services. In these letters and other agreements, the clients acknowledge that they will pay us based upon our time spent on the matter and at our agreed-upon hourly rates. Revenues recognized but not yet billed to clients, have been recorded as unbilled receivables in the accompanying consolidated balance sheets. Billings in excess of services provided represents amounts billed to clients, such as retainers, in advance of work being performed.

 

27


Table of Contents

 

Some clients pay us retainers before we begin any work for them. We hold retainers on deposit until we have completed the work. We apply these retainers to final billings or refund any excess over the final amount billed to clients, as appropriate, upon our completion of the work. If the client is in bankruptcy, fees for our professional services are subject to approval by the court. In some cases, a portion of the fees to be paid to us by a client is required to be held by a court until completion of our work. We make the initial determination whether to record all or a portion of such a holdback as revenue prior to collection on a case-by-case basis.

 

Bad Debts.    We also maintain an allowance for doubtful accounts for estimated losses resulting from the inability of our clients to pay our fees or for disputes that affect our ability to fully collect our billed accounts receivable as well as potential fee reductions imposed by bankruptcy courts. We estimate this allowance by reviewing the status of past-due accounts and recording general reserves based on our experiences in these cases and historical bad debt expense. Our actual experience has not varied significantly from our estimates. However, if the financial condition of our clients were to deteriorate, resulting in their inability to pay our fees, we may need to record additional allowances in future periods. This risk is mitigated by the retainers that we require from some of our clients prior to performing significant services.

 

We believe that the addition of BRS will not have a significant effect on our bad debt expense as a percentage of revenue.

 

Goodwill.    We have remaining goodwill from continuing operations of about $318.2 million at September 30, 2002 that we recorded for business combinations that we completed principally in the last five years. In prior years, this goodwill had been amortizing over 20 to 25 year periods and resulted in amortization expense approximating $4.2 million in 2001. As of January 1, 2002, we adopted Financial Accounting Standards Board Statement No. 142, Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets (“Statement 142”). Under the new rules, goodwill and other intangible assets deemed to have indefinite lives are no longer amortized but are subject to annual impairment tests in accordance with the Statement. Accordingly, we no longer amortize this goodwill, but rather make annual assessments of impairment. During the second quarter of 2002, we completed the transitional impairment tests required by Statement 142 for this goodwill as of January 1, 2002. No impairment of goodwill was identified as a result of these tests. In the future, we will be making impairment tests during the fourth quarter of each year. In making these impairment assessments, we must make subjective judgments regarding estimated future cash flows and other factors to determine the fair value of the reporting units of our business that are associated with this goodwill. It is possible that these judgments may change over time as market conditions or our strategies change, and these changes may cause us to record impairment charges to adjust our goodwill to its estimated fair value.

 

Effect of Recent Accounting Pronouncements

 

As of January 1, 2002, the Company adopted Financial Accounting Standards Board Statement No. 144, Accounting for the Impairment or Disposal of Long-Lived Assets (“Statement 144”). Statement 144 supersedes and serves to clarify and further define the provisions of Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No. 121, Accounting for the Impairment of Long-Lived Assets and for Long-Lived Assets to Be Disposed Of, and provides a single accounting model for long-lived assets to be disposed of.

 

Statement 144 does not apply to goodwill and other intangible assets that are not amortized, and retains the Company's current policy to recognize an impairment loss only if the carrying amount of a long-lived asset is not recoverable from its undiscounted future cash flows and to measure the impairment loss as the difference between the carrying amount and the fair value of the asset.

 

In April 2002, the Financial Accounting Standards Board issued Statement of Financial Accounting Standard No. 145, Recission of FASB Statements No. 4, 44, and 64, Amendment of FASB Statement No. 13, and Technical Corrections (“Statement 145”). Among other changes, Statement 145 rescinds Statement 4, which required all gains and losses from extinguishment of debt to be aggregated and classified as an extraordinary

 

28


Table of Contents

item, net of the related tax effect. Statement 145 provides that gains and losses from extinguishment of debt should be classified as extraordinary items only if they are unusual or infrequent or they otherwise meet the criteria for classification as an extraordinary item, and observes that debt extinguishment transactions would seldom, if ever, result in extraordinary item classification of the resulting gains and losses. We will adopt Statement 145 in January 2003, and upon adoption, we will report as other expenses any extraordinary losses that we incur upon the extinguishment of our debt. In addition, when we present for comparative purposes financial statements issued prior to December 31, 2002, we will reclassify to other expenses any extraordinary losses that we recorded upon the early extinguishment of debt in those periods. In 2000, we reported a $5.4 million loss from the early extinguishment of certain debt. We may incur an extraordinary loss from the early extinguishment of our debt from this offering, as well as from application of the proceeds from our intended sale of our applied sciences practice group if the sale occurs in 2002.

 

In July 2002, the Financial Accounting Standards Board issued Statement of Financial Accounting Standard No. 146, Accounting for Costs Associated with Exit or Disposal Activities (“Statement 146”). Statement 146 supersedes EITF Issue No. 94-3 Liability Recognition for Certain Employee Termination Benefits and Other Costs to Exit an Activity. Statement 146 requires that costs associated with an exit or disposal plan be recognized when incurred rather than at the date of a commitment to an exit or disposal plan. Statement 146 is to be applied prospectively to exit or disposal activities initiated after December 31, 2002. We do not expect that our adoption of Statement 146 will have a material effect on our reported results of operations and financial position.

 

Recent Acquisitions

 

We have made three acquisitions since the beginning of 2000, each of which was treated as a purchase business combination for accounting purposes:

 

Company


 

Date Acquired


 

Purchase Price


  

Goodwill and Other Intangibles Recorded


 

Sources of Cash Financing


 

Services


       

(in table, dollars in millions)

       

U.S. BRS division of PwC

 

Aug. 2002

 

$243.2, in cash and stock(1)

  

 

$243.7

 

Bank financing and our available cash

 

Turnaround, restructuring and bankruptcy consulting

Technology & Financial Consulting, Inc.

 

Jan. 2002

 

$4.1, in cash and stock(2)

  

$

3.8

 

Available cash

 

Intellectual property consulting

Policano & Manzo, L.L.C.

 

Feb. 2000

 

$54.9, in cash and stock(3)

  

$

52.2

 

Bank financing and our available cash

 

Turnaround, restructuring and bankruptcy consulting


 

(1) The purchase price consisted of $22.3 million of available cash, incurred debt of $119.0 million and 3,000,000 shares of common stock valued at $101.9 million.

 

(2) The purchase price consisted of $3.1 million of available cash, and 46,216 shares of common stock valued at $1.0 million.

 

(3) The purchase price consisted of $1.9 million of available cash, incurred debt of $47.5 million and 1,222,000 shares of common stock valued at $5.5 million.

 

29


Table of Contents

 

Results of Continuing Operations

 

Nine Months Ended September 30, 2002 and 2001

 

Revenues.    Revenues from continuing operations for the nine months ended September 30, 2002 increased 45.5% to $133.6 million compared with $91.8 million in the same period in 2001. This growth was primarily attributable to our ability to recruit seasoned financial professionals to meet the continued strong demand for our consulting services, as well as the acquisitions of TFC and BRS during the year. The number of our financial professionals at September 30, 2002 grew 175.3% from September 30, 2001; of this growth, 144.4% occurred as a result of our acquisition of BRS. During the first quarter of 2002, we also raised our professional rates by an average of 8%. We believe that the market demand for our services will continue to remain strong throughout the remainder of 2002. The new practice areas we added during the year have contributed to the revenues and operating income during the first three quarters of 2002.

 

Direct Cost of Revenues.    Direct cost of revenues of our continuing operations was 49.1% of our total revenues during the first nine months of 2002 and 50.9% in the same period in 2001. The improvement in 2002 resulted primarily from the relative growth of our turnaround, restructuring and bankruptcy practice area, which has a somewhat higher gross margin than our other practice areas.

 

Selling, General and Administrative Expenses.    As a percent of our total revenues, these expenses, which include depreciation and amortization of property and equipment, were 24.6% in the first nine months of 2002, and 25.7% in the same period in 2001. This decline is primarily the result of the growth in our turnaround, restructuring and bankruptcy services, which have a lower selling and general administrative expense as a percent of revenues than our other practice areas.

 

Amortization of Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets.    As required by Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No. 142, Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets, we no longer amortize goodwill, beginning January 1, 2002. Amortization of goodwill of continuing operations during the first three quarters of 2001 was $3.2 million. In connection with the acquisition of BRS, we recorded approximately $5.1 million of other intangible assets, consisting primarily of client backlog, which are being amortized over their useful lives ranging from 18 to 36 months. The value and useful lives of other intangible assets were determined through an appraisal. We began to amortize these other intangible assets in September 2002, and amortization expense in the third quarter of 2002 was $252,000.

 

Interest Income and Expense, Net.    Net interest expense consisted primarily of interest on debt we incurred to purchase businesses over the past several years. Interest rates during 2002 have been lower than in the prior year. As a result, interest expense during the first three quarters of 2002 was $2.7 million, compared to $3.7 million during the same period of the prior year despite our additional borrowings in August 2002 to acquire BRS.

 

Income Taxes.    Our effective tax rate for continuing operations throughout the first three quarters of 2002 is 40.2%, compared to 41.5% for the same period in 2001. We expect our effective tax rate from continuing operations to approximate 40.0% for 2002.

 

Years Ended December 31, 2001, 2000, and 1999

 

Revenues.    Total revenues in 2001 increased 28.1% to $122.3 million from $95.5 million in 2000. We believe revenues grew during 2001 primarily as a result of our ability to recruit seasoned financial professionals to meet the continued strong demand for our services in both restructuring and turnaround activities and the forensic accounting and strategic consulting portions of the business, coupled with increases in professional rates. The number of our financial professionals at December 31, 2001 grew 8.1% from December 31, 2000. We added several new practice areas in early 2002, including crisis management, intellectual property litigation consulting, electronic evidence discovery, and utility regulatory financial consulting.

 

30


Table of Contents

 

Total revenues in 2000 increased 95.3% to $95.5 million from $48.9 million in 1999, primarily as the result of our acquisition of Policano & Manzo, LLC (“P&M”) early in 2000 and the successful integration of its financial professionals into our existing practices. Our headcount at year-end 2000 increased by approximately 50% when compared to the prior year, as the result of the acquisition of P&M and our successful recruiting efforts.

 

Direct Cost of Revenues.    Direct cost of revenues was 48.3% of our total revenues in 2001, 51.3% in 2000 and 52.3% in 1999. The improvement in 2001 resulted primarily from the broader implementation of incentive compensation programs that promote increased billable hours by our professional staff, and the continued strong demand for our services. Employee compensation accounted for 75% of direct cost of revenues in 2001.

 

Selling, General and Administrative Expenses.    As a percent of our total revenues, selling, general, and administrative expenses, which include depreciation and amortization of property and equipment, were 27.0% in 2001, 25.0% in 2000 and 33.8% in 1999. The slight increase in 2001 is the result of costs incurred to open larger offices in several major cities, including New York and Washington, DC. The decrease in 2000 is the result of the substantial increases in revenues, since selling, general and administrative expenses, such as rent, are relatively fixed costs.

 

Amortization of Goodwill.    Annual amortization of goodwill increased from $3.9 million in 2000 to $4.2 million in 2001, primarily as a result of additional contingent consideration related to our acquisitions. Amortization of goodwill increased from $1.6 million in 1999 primarily as a result of the P&M acquisition.

 

Interest Income and Expense, Net.    Interest expense consisted primarily of interest on debt we incurred to purchase businesses over the past several years. Interest expense decreased substantially in 2001 as compared to 2000 because interest rates were lower and we were able to retire $32.3 million of our debt. We used cash generated from operations, the proceeds of an equity offering in October 2000 and proceeds from the exercise of options and warrants to pay down debt. We achieved lower interest rates by refinancing our outstanding debt in late 2000 and experienced declining market interest rates on our revolving credit facility.

 

Income Taxes.    Our effective tax rate decreased to 40.0% in 2001 from 41.2% in 2000, principally because the increase in our net income diluted the effect of non-deductible goodwill amortization. See Note 8 of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements for a reconciliation of the federal statutory rate to our effective tax rates during each of these years, and a summary of the components of our deferred tax assets and liabilities.

 

Extraordinary Loss on Early Extinguishment of Debt, Net of Income Taxes.    As a result of the write-off of unamortized debt discount and deferred financing costs associated with the debt that we refinanced or retired early in 2000, we had a $5.4 million loss on early extinguishment of debt, net of taxes in 2000.

 

Liquidity and Capital Resources

 

During the nine months ended September 30, 2002, net cash provided by our operations was about $28.4 million as compared to about $19.4 million for the comparable period in 2001. Net cash provided by operating activities was $35.4 million in 2001, $15.6 million in 2000, and $8.4 million in 1999. We continue to finance operations and capital expenditures solely through cash flows from operations. Cash flows from operations have improved year-over-year since 1999 primarily due to increases in net income. During the nine months ended September 30, 2002, this increase occurred primarily because our total revenues from continuing operations increased by 45.4%, while our direct cost of revenues and our selling, general and administrative expenses declined as a percentage of revenues. Additionally, we realized a $9.1 million income tax benefit from stock option exercises that further increased our cash flows from operations during the nine months ended September 30, 2002.

 

Our operating assets and liabilities consist primarily of billed and unbilled accounts receivable, accounts payable and accrued expenses and accrued compensation expense. Changes in these balances are affected by the

 

31


Table of Contents

timing of billings and collections of receivables as well as payments for compensation arrangements. During the nine months ended September 30, 2002, changes in operating assets and liabilities reduced cash flow from operations by $8.2 million. This was primarily because our billed and unbilled accounts receivables grew by $16.2 million during the nine months ended September 30, 2002. Billed and unbilled accounts receivable, net of allowance for doubtful accounts, increased due to the additional clients obtained through our acquisition of BRS and continued strong demand for our financial consulting services throughout 2002. Our average collection period did not vary significantly from 2001 to 2002. Our customary collection terms range from 30 to 60 days for all of our clients. We do not expect our collection trends to change significantly as a result of the acquisition of BRS.

 

During the nine months ended September 30, 2002, we spent $5.9 million for net additions to property and equipment, primarily for expansion of one of our major offices and investments in technology and equipment for our new practice areas. During all of 2002, we expect to spend approximately $8.0 million for property and equipment additions, including $2.0 million related to the integration of BRS. This trend in investing activities, after giving effect to the recent acquisition of BRS, is in line with our historical net additions to property and equipment of $4.4 million in 2001, $6.6 million in 2000 and $3.1 million in 1999. In 2003, we expect to spend approximately $10.0 million for property and equipment additions, including $4.0 million related to the integration of BRS. We had no outstanding purchase commitments at September 30, 2002.

 

Our investment activities during the nine months ended September 30, 2002 included the acquisition of two businesses. We paid $3.1 million in cash as part of the purchase price to acquire Technology & Financial Consulting, Inc., which provides intellectual property consulting services. We paid $141.3 million in cash as part of the purchase price to acquire BRS.

 

Our financing activities in all periods have consisted principally of borrowings and repayments under long-term debt arrangements as well as issuances of common stock and exercises of warrants and stock options. Net borrowings or repayments under debt arrangements consisted of a $32.3 million repayment in 2001, a $20.7 million borrowing in 2000 and a $2.5 million repayment in 1999. We borrowed $119.0 million in the third quarter of 2002 to acquire BRS. During the nine months ended September 30, 2002, we repaid $8.3 million in debt. At September 30, 2002, we had availability under our revolving line of credit of $60.0 million.

 

During the nine months ended September 30, 2002, stock options to purchase 956,296 shares of our common stock were exercised and 111,661 shares of our common stock were issued under our employee stock purchase plan. These exercises and issuances generated $15.7 million in cash (including the $9.1 million income tax benefit from the stock option exercises).

 

On August 30, 2002, we completed the acquisition of BRS. The purchase price consisted of $141.3 million in cash plus 3,000,000 shares of our common stock. We financed the cash portion of the purchase price from our existing cash and a new bank credit facility, which consists of an additional term loan of $74.0 million and a revolving credit line of $100.0 million. We acquired BRS related accounts receivable, unbilled receivables and obligations to perform services under retainers but did not acquire BRS related cash.

 

On August 30, 2002, we terminated our previous credit facility and entered into the new credit facility in connection with our acquisition of BRS. The new credit facility consisted of our then existing term loan for $26.0 million, a new term loan for $74.0 million and a new revolving credit facility for $100.0 million. On September 30, 2002, we repaid $1.1 million of the $26.0 million term loan. Our debt under the credit facility bears interest at an annual rate equal to LIBOR plus an applicable margin or an alternative base rate defined as the higher of (1) the lender’s announced prime rate or (2) the federal funds rate plus the sum of 50 basis points and an applicable margin. If not prepaid, our $24.9 million term loan will mature on December 1, 2005, and our $74.0 million term loan will mature on August 30, 2006. Under the credit facility, we have granted the lenders a security interest in substantially all of our assets. At September 30, 2002, we had outstanding aggregate debt under the credit facility of $138.9 million, bearing interest at 4.95% per annum. We will not be subject to any

 

32


Table of Contents

penalties for early payment of the debt under the credit facility. Under the provisions of the credit facility, we must apply at least half of the net proceeds that we obtain from any public offering of our equity securities to repayment of the debt. Because of our increased debt, we anticipate higher interest expenses for the remainder of 2002 and thereafter. We will apply all of our net proceeds of the offering to reduce our outstanding debt. Also, we expect to use cash flows from our operations to further reduce our debt. Assuming we do not make any acquisitions, we expect to repay all amounts under the credit facility by the end of 2003.

 

We intend to sell our applied sciences practice group, and we expect to complete the sale of the entire applied sciences practice group by the end of 2003. Depending on the sale price and the tax structure of the transaction, the amount realized after taxes from the sale may be less than the carrying value. Under the credit facility, we are required to apply all of the proceeds from the sale to reduce our outstanding aggregate debt under the facility.

 

We expect that cash generated from our operations and cash available under our credit facility will be sufficient to meet our normal operating requirements for the foreseeable future.

 

Below is a summary of our contractual obligations and commitments at September 30, 2002:

 

   

Payments Due by Period


 
   

(in thousands)

 

Contractual Obligations


 

Total


   

2002


   

2003


   

2004


   

2005


    

Thereafter


 

Long-term debt

 

$

138,916

 

 

$

1,083

 

 

$

20,000

 

 

$

26,417

 

 

$

30,000

 

  

$

61,416

 

Operating leases

 

 

34,582

 

 

 

1,468

 

 

 

5,876

 

 

 

5,576

 

 

 

5,235

 

  

 

16,427

 

   


 


 


 


 


  


Total obligations

 

$

173,498

 

 

$

2,551

 

 

$

25,876

 

 

$

31,993

 

 

$

35,235

 

  

$

77,843

 

Operating leases of discontinued operations

 

 

(5,924

)

 

 

(403

)

 

 

(1,568

)

 

 

(1,365

)

 

 

(1,349

)

  

 

(1,239

)

   


 


 


 


 


  


Total obligations of continuing operations

 

$

167,574

 

 

$

2,148

 

 

$

24,308

 

 

$

30,628

 

 

$

33,886

 

  

$

76,604

 

   


 


 


 


 


  


As adjusted long-term debt (1)

 

$

58,631

 

 

$

1,083

 

 

$

20,000

 

 

$

26,417

 

 

$

11,131

 

  

$

0

 

Operating leases from continuing operations

 

 

28,658

 

 

 

1,065

 

 

 

4,308

 

 

 

4,211

 

 

 

3,886

 

  

 

15,188

 

   


 


 


 


 


  


As adjusted total obligations (1)

 

$

87,289

 

 

$

2,148

 

 

$

24,308

 

 

$

30,628

 

 

$

15,017

 

  

$

15,188

 

   


 


 


 


 


  



(1) We calculated as adjusted information assuming our repayment at September 30, 2002 of $80.3 million of our debt under our credit facility with the estimated net proceeds from the sale of shares by us in this offering. This information does not give effect to our planned sale of the applied sciences practice group (which would lower the amount of our debt and the number of leases) or any additional leases we may enter into as we integrate BRS. We intend to relocate BRS as soon as possible and expect to obtain additional leased facilities on commercially reasonable terms.

 

Quantitative And Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk

 

We are subject to market risk associated with changes in interest rates on our variable rate debt. In the past, we have managed this risk by entering into interest rate swaps. These hedges reduce our exposure to rising interest rates, but also reduce the benefits we would have otherwise received from lower interest rates. We do not anticipate entering into new interest rate swaps in 2002.

 

Interest rate swaps with notional principal amounts of $24.9 million at September 30, 2002, were designated as hedges against outstanding debt and were used to convert the interest rate on our variable rate debt to fixed rates for the life of the swap. Without giving effect to our hedge, our interest rate would have been 4.09% at September 30, 2002, but because of the hedge, the rate was 8.39% at that date. Because of the effectiveness of our hedge of variable interest rates associated with our debt, the change in fair value of our interest rate swaps resulting from changes in market interest rates is reported as a component of other comprehensive income (loss).

 

33


Table of Contents

 

BUSINESS

 

Introduction

 

We are one of the largest U.S. providers of turnaround, restructuring, bankruptcy and related consulting services. Our highly skilled professionals assist distressed companies in improving their financial position or their creditors or other stakeholders in maximizing recovery of their claims. We quickly analyze and implement an array of strategic alternatives, such as rightsizing infrastructure, improving working capital management, selling non-core assets or business units and restructuring capital. Through our corporate recovery services, we can help financially distressed companies implement their plans by providing interim management teams. Our teams of professionals have extensive experience in crisis management, negotiations of complex mergers, acquisitions and capital restructurings, as well as the liquidation of surplus assets.

 

We also help clients in all phases of litigation, including pre-filing, discovery, jury selection, trial preparation, expert testimony and the actual trial. We assist with refining issues in litigation and venue selection, and provide fraud investigation and securities litigation assistance. Our trial graphics and technology and electronic evidence experts assist clients in preparing for and presenting their cases in court. Furthermore, we provide forensic accounting and economic consulting services. Our forensic accounting and data mining (sorting through large volumes of data) services help clients to unravel complex financial transactions and reconstruct events from incomplete and/or corrupt data. Our specialized expertise in economic consulting allows us to help clients in valuing assets of all types and entire businesses, as well as intellectual property disputes. Our industry expertise extends to the telecommunications, railroad, energy and electric utility industries. In recent months, we have begun initiatives in the merger and acquisition area and dispute settlement services.

 

We began operations in 1982 as a consulting firm focused on providing forensic engineering scientific and trial support services. Beginning in 1998, we further expanded into financial consulting services. We achieved this expansion through two acquisitions in 1998 and one acquisition in 2000 and through our internal growth initiatives. Through a combination of organic growth and acquisitions, we have become one of the largest U.S. providers of turnaround, restructuring, bankruptcy and related consulting services. Our revenues from continuing operations have grown from $32.2 million in 1997 to $122.3 million in 2001, at a compounded annual growth rate of nearly 40%. For the first nine months of 2002, we had $133.6 million in revenues on an actual basis and $242.6 million in revenues on a pro forma basis, which includes BRS revenues but excludes revenues from our applied sciences practice group, which we have announced our intention to sell.

 

On August 30, 2002, we acquired BRS for $141.3 million in cash and 3,000,000 shares of our common stock valued at $101.9 million. For its fiscal year ended June 30, 2002, BRS had revenues of $179.3 million and operating income of $66.8 million. On a pro forma basis, as adjusted to present BRS as a company separate from PwC, BRS had revenues of $167.2 million and operating income of $40.0 million for the year ended December 31, 2001, and revenues of $109.0 million and operating income of $24.0 million for the eight-month period ended August 30, 2002.

 

We believe our acquisition of BRS greatly enhances our ability to provide consulting services in the largest and most complex U.S. turnarounds, restructurings and bankruptcies. The BRS professionals have developed a premier practice handling turnarounds, restructurings and bankruptcies of comparable scale and complexity as we have. As a result of the acquisition of BRS, we have added 371 professionals, including the 49 BRS partners we hired, to our pool of talented, experienced professionals. The BRS acquisition also significantly diversifies our client base, including an increase in debtor-side clients to complement our historical strength in serving creditor-side clients. Immediately after the acquisition, we began integrating BRS into our turnaround, restructuring and bankruptcy practice group.

 

Our clients are typically companies facing adverse circumstances, as well as their creditors or other stakeholders, such as financial institutions and private equity firms, and the law firms that represent them. Unlike demand for traditional consulting services, which depends primarily on companies’ internal budgeting decisions,

 

34


Table of Contents

demand for our services is driven by non-discretionary engagements for businesses facing critical situations that are often adverse. These companies typically focus on our track record and reputation rather than our prices. In the case of bankruptcy proceedings, bankruptcy courts often mandate the selection of third party advisors, reinforcing the non-discretionary nature of our services.

 

We regularly provide our turnaround, restructuring, bankruptcy and related consulting services to the largest banks in the U.S., including Bank of America, N.A., Wachovia Bank, N.A, and JP Morgan Chase Bank. We are involved in many of the largest bankruptcy proceedings and out-of-court restructurings in the U.S. For example, we are currently involved in the bankruptcies of Enron Corp., WorldCom, Inc., US Airways, Inc. and Adelphia Communications Corporation. We believe clients retain us because of our recognized expertise and capabilities in highly specialized areas, as well as our reputation for satisfying clients’ needs. In 2001 and in the nine months ended September 30, 2002, no single client accounted for more than 5% of our revenues.

 

Our applied sciences practice group offers forensic engineering and scientific investigation services. We intend to sell the entire practice group. As of December 31, 2002, we sold a part of the applied sciences practice group for a total consideration of $4.2 million, including a seven year note of $2.0 million. We incurred a loss after taxes of $891,000 in connection with this sale. We expect to complete the sale of the entire applied sciences practice group by the end of 2003. We intend to use the proceeds from the sale to reduce our outstanding debt under our credit facility. However, we cannot assure you that we will be able to sell our entire applied sciences practice group within the stated timeframe or at what price we will be able to sell it. Depending on the sale price and the tax structure of the transaction, the amount realized after taxes from the sale may be less than the carrying value.

 

Industry Overview

 

Participants in our industry provide a broad range of financial consulting services to companies facing adverse circumstances or their creditors or other stakeholders. These services include turnaround, restructuring, bankruptcy, forensic accounting and trial support services. We believe demand for services in our industry will continue to be strong, driven by a number of current and anticipated trends, including:

 

    high debt default rates and ongoing bankruptcy filings;

 

    continuing use of debt for corporate financings;

 

    escalating competitive and regulatory complexity faced by a wide range of businesses;

 

    the current wave of corporate reform legislation that encourages, and in some cases, requires the use of outside financial consultants; and

 

    the need for objective, independent expertise for critical, business processes.

 

We believe that our reputation, national scale and large staff of highly qualified professionals position us well to capitalize on the trends driving the growth in our industry.

 

Trends in Debt Default Rates.    We believe that corporate debt default levels are important indicators of the potential need for turnaround, restructuring, bankruptcy and related consulting services. The current economic environment provides significant opportunity to companies capable of providing these services.

 

According to Moody’s Investor Service, 186 corporate issuers of debt rated either investment grade or speculative grade by Moody’s defaulted on $106 billion of debt in 2001, compared to $33.4 billion in 2000. In 2001, Moody’s also estimated that the dollar volume of the ten largest debt defaults exceeded the total dollar volume of all Moody’s-rated defaults in 2000. In 2001, Moody’s rating downgrades exceeded its upgrades by an almost two-to-one margin.

 

For the first half of 2002, Moody’s reported that 89 issuers of corporate bond debt rated either investment grade or speculative grade by it defaulted on $76.7 billion of that debt. This represents a 64% increase in the

 

35


Table of Contents

dollar volume of defaulted debt from the first half of 2001. In the second quarter of 2002 alone, 42 issuers of Moody’s-rated corporate bond debt defaulted on $42.6 billion in debt, representing approximately twice the defaulted amount as the first quarter of 2001. Moody’s reported second quarter 2002 global default rates for speculative grade debt (also known as “junk bonds”) at 10.3%, consistent with default rates seen in other periods of economic distress over the past 30 years, including 2001 (10.2%), 1991 (10.5%), 1990 (9.9%) and 1970 (9.2%). In July 2002, Moody’s reported that the second quarter of 2002 was one of the most severe periods of credit deterioration since the Great Depression.

 

We believe that a high correlation exists between default rates on all corporate debt and the number of bankruptcy filings. According to the FDIC, a record 257 publicly-traded companies filed for bankruptcy in 2001, representing a 46% increase over the previous record set in 2000. The FDIC also reported that $258.5 billion of assets were involved in U.S. public company bankruptcy filings in 2001. This represented more than twice the assets involved in all 2000 U.S. public company bankruptcies. While the highly visible and large scale publicly-traded company bankruptcies draw the most attention, BankruptcyData.com reported a total of 40,099 total business bankruptcy filings in 2001, less than the 1980 through 2001 annual average of 58,871 business bankruptcy filings. Regardless of prevailing economic conditions, we believe that there will be a substantial number of business bankruptcy filings in any given year.

 

Continuing Use of Corporate Debt.    Although the increased number of debt defaults has generated higher demand for restructuring and restructuring-related services in recent years, we believe demand for these services will remain robust even in periods of general economic recovery. While default rates historically have fluctuated depending upon the state of the economy, the size of the debt market, as measured by the amount of aggregate U.S. corporate debt outstanding, has consistently expanded over the past 30 years, regardless of economic cycles. U.S. and international companies have increasingly relied on debt to finance acquisitions, growth initiatives and working capital requirements. According to the Bond Market Association, the amount of U.S. corporate bond debt outstanding increased from $777 billion in 1985 to $3.8 trillion in 2001, a compounded annual growth rate of 10.4%. The outstanding amount of speculative grade debt consistently increased between 1985 and 2001, from $58 billion to $649 billion, a compounded annual growth rate of 16.3%. Although the default rate may fluctuate from time to time, an increasing aggregate volume of corporate debt suggests that the aggregate volume of corporate debt under default should remain high.

 

Although debt default rates tend to decline during periods of economic expansion, we believe that economic expansion also facilitates new issuances of speculative grade debt, as investors are generally willing to tolerate higher levels of risk during these periods. We believe that most speculative grade bond defaults take place within the first three years after issuance. As such, we believe that economic expansion periods could ultimately result in an increased volume of debt defaults, increasing demand for turnaround, restructuring, bankruptcy and related consulting services in the future.

 

Escalating Complexity in the Competitive and Regulatory Environment.    We believe that many of the factors driving our industry are non-cyclical. These factors include under-performing companies, ineffective business strategies, highly leveraged capital structures, failed acquisitions and roll-ups, corporate fraud, the continuing trend in high-stakes litigation and the adverse effect of increased regulation on entire industries. For example, the Sarbanes-Oxley legislation has added a layer of complex regulatory requirements for public companies. Faced with recent enhanced scrutiny by investors and government agencies of financial reporting and corporate governance, in part as a result of this legislation, companies have begun to hire outside professionals to review and analyze their accounting records and financial reporting. We anticipate that ever increasing litigation costs will require businesses to focus on better managing risks and the litigation process, particularly in large, complex, multi-jurisdiction cases and mass tort claims. We believe that recent mandates as a result of the Sarbanes-Oxley legislation, and the emerging trend toward hiring consulting firms unaffiliated with company auditors, represent a fundamental shift in corporate and governmental policy. These trends should directly benefit independent financial consulting service providers in both distress and non-distress oriented projects.

 

36


Table of Contents

 

Increasing Need For Independent Expertise.    We believe that businesses, their creditors and other institutional stakeholders are increasingly utilizing consulting firms to provide objective, independent expertise for highly critical business processes. Businesses and financial institutions facing adverse circumstances have a need to access world-class expertise to assist them in implementing tactical operating plans to solve significant business dilemmas. This is particularly true in highly complex and sophisticated areas such as turnarounds, restructurings, bankruptcies and high-stakes legal proceedings.

 

Business Strategy

 

We are one of the largest U.S. providers of turnaround, restructuring, bankruptcy and related consulting services. We intend to continue to provide high caliber financial consulting services through our staff of professionals who are able to quickly staff even the most complex assignments. We also intend to try to anticipate our clients’ needs by expanding the range of consulting services we offer. Success in our marketplace depends primarily on having a reputation for providing quality and timely service and the ability to quickly address and staff very large assignments. The following are the key elements of our business strategy:

 

    Maintain High Utilization Rates Among Our Professionals.    We carefully manage our growth in order to maintain high utilization rates among all of our professionals rather than intermittently expanding our staff in anticipation of short-term demand. We take a disciplined approach when recruiting additional professionals. Although we maintain enough professionals to staff large, complex assignments, we focus on hiring qualified individuals who meet our selective criteria. High utilization rates allow us to maintain our profitability and make us less vulnerable to temporary declines in our work load.

 

    Retain a Critical Mass of Highly Qualified Professionals.    Our professionals are crucial to delivering our services to clients and generating new business. Through our substantial staff of highly qualified professionals, we can handle a number of large, complex assignments simultaneously. We offer each of our professionals significant compensation opportunities, often based on his or her utilization rate, along with a competitive benefits package and the chance to work on challenging engagements.

 

    Leverage Our Relationships and Expertise.    We work hard to maintain our existing client relationships and develop new ones. We believe that our existing client relationships and our reputation among industry professionals, coupled with our recognized expertise, track record and size, are the most critical elements in a company’s decision to retain us. We have typically received a significant amount of repeat business from our financial institution clients and referrals from our law firm clients. We have been successful in recent years in expanding the range of consulting services we provide to our clients. Moreover, as a result of the BRS acquisition, we have greater capacity to handle simultaneously a number of complex, high-profile matters. By successfully leveraging our reputation, experience and expanded client base, we believe we will obtain a greater number of engagements from both existing and new clients.

 

    Expand the Range of Our Financial and Litigation Consulting Services.    We believe that a number of factors driving demand for our services are non-cyclical in nature. These factors include the adverse effects of increased regulation and competition on various industries, under-performing companies, ineffective business strategies, highly leveraged capital structures, failed acquisitions, corporate fraud and the ever increasing number of high-stakes lawsuits. While we anticipate that during more prosperous economic times, demand for turnaround, restructuring, bankruptcy and related consulting services will continue, we intend to continue to diversify the range of our financial and litigation consulting services. We have recently diversified our service offerings to include lender and transactional support, dispute settlement, intellectual property consulting and mergers and acquisitions advice. We intend to continue to broaden the range of our service offerings. We believe this diversification of our service offerings will better insulate our overall business from changing market conditions.

 

   

Selectively Acquire Companies to Obtain New Professionals and Capabilities.    We have always followed a disciplined approach to acquisitions. Our selective approach has allowed us to acquire

 

37


Table of Contents
 

businesses on attractive terms. Over the past five years, we have made three significant acquisitions that have greatly enhanced our position in the turnaround, restructuring and bankruptcy market. We will continue to selectively pursue strategic acquisitions of complementary service businesses. This should enable us to expand the range of consulting services we offer our existing client base, expand our staff of expert professionals and add new clients to which we can sell our existing services.

 

Our Services

 

Turnaround, Restructuring and Bankruptcy Practice.    Our turnaround, restructuring and bankruptcy professionals regularly advise companies and creditors in some of the largest, most complex bankruptcy proceedings and out-of-court restructurings in the U.S. When advising a corporate client, we work with the company’s management to assess the client’s financial condition and viability and structure and implement a business rehabilitation plan to manage the client’s cash flow to at least a break-even point. We also identify any non-essential assets or business units that could be sold to generate cash for the client. Typically, we then assist these clients as they negotiate with their lenders to restructure their debt. If an out-of-court workout appears unlikely, we assess the impact of a bankruptcy filing on the client’s financial condition and operating performance and seek debtor-in-possession financing on the client’s behalf. If the client voluntarily files for bankruptcy or is involuntarily forced into bankruptcy, we assist in managing the entire bankruptcy process, including structuring, negotiating with creditors and implementing the plan of reorganization. We also provide expert testimony in bankruptcy proceedings on such issues as business unit valuation and economic loss.

 

When we represent creditors, we seek to maximize amounts owed to them by the debtor, whether in an out-of-court workout or bankruptcy. In a workout engagement, we evaluate and monitor the quality and value of the collateral and any other assets available to the creditor, analyze the debtor’s business plan and underlying cash flow projections and assess the adequacy of the debtor’s financial reporting systems. Based on our analysis, we then assess the debtor’s viability and develop and evaluate restructuring plans. If we conclude that an out-of-court workout is not feasible, we assist the creditors in deciding whether to provide debtor-in-possession financing, in working through the bankruptcy process and in structuring and evaluating various reorganization plan alternatives.

 

To better meet the needs of companies suffering a financial or operating crisis, we also offer corporate recovery services. The experienced professionals in our corporate recovery practice group are able to assume interim senior management roles at companies in crisis. Our professionals can function as a chief executive officer, chief operating officer, chief financial officer or chief recovery officer. Our professionals utilize their seasoned business judgment to reevaluate business strategy and financial forecasts and implement plans to meet financial and operating challenges. Our creative approaches and innovative solutions can create short-term liquidity to stabilize the business and afford the distressed company time to explore its options. Our teams of senior experienced professionals are keenly aware of the sensitive nature of these arrangements and the need to build consensus around a realistic restructuring plan.

 

Forensic Accounting Practice.    Our forensic accounting specialists work with companies faced with fraud and financial disclosure issues. Many of these companies are undergoing restructuring or bankruptcy reorganizations. As perpetrators of fraud become more ingenious, the expertise required to unravel their schemes increases. We have a team of forensic accountants, certified fraud examiners and computer technicians who are experts in discovering and analyzing the most sophisticated ways to circumvent internal financial controls. Our forensic accountants routinely unravel complex transactions, reconstruct events from incomplete and/or corrupt data, uncover vital evidence, identify potential claims and assist in the pursuit of recoveries. Our computer technicians utilize sophisticated software tools to analyze and uncover important information from the computer systems used in the frauds. With our advanced search techniques and innovative methods, we are able to uncover valuable information that was considered lost, deleted or hidden.

 

We also provide asset tracing investigative services. Our forensic accountants and computer experts analyze corporate and personal records and electronic information, conduct interviews and evaluate related financial

 

38


Table of Contents

information to trace the flow of funds and locate assets that may have been misappropriated due to illegal or fraudulent activity. Our financial experts utilize sophisticated software tools, advanced data mining and search techniques as well as databases to conduct asset searches for companies, government agencies and individuals. We have provided investigative services in diverse cases involving misdirected or stolen assets, embezzlements and bank, healthcare, insurance and bankruptcy frauds.

 

Trial Support Practice.    We develop and deliver creative solutions to litigation problems. From the first computer animations used in court to the latest in digital graphic presentations, we have been one of the leaders in providing high-quality, cost-effective methods to prepare for and try cases. Our trial technology professionals have supported clients in the courtroom in some of the largest and most complex civil trials. Through the use of information technology and the Internet, we have demonstrated our ability to help control litigation costs, speed-up the trial process and provide litigants with superior access to data, a key competitive advantage.

 

We prepare and enhance presentations and expert testimony on complex subjects, such as toxic torts, financial disputes and intellectual property resolutions. We have responded to the increasing demand for document management in cases involving thousands or even millions of pages of depositions, testimony and exhibits by developing document management and exhibit and trial preparation solutions that enable our clients to better focus on preparing for and trying cases. Our range of services for complex litigation matters include visual communication consulting services; graphic exhibit design and production; customized database development and distribution; video deposition capture and transcript linking; management of designated trial exhibits; courtroom survey, design and configuration; on-site technical trial support; trial-specific hardware procurement and tracking; and secure extranet storage and distribution of data, documents, transcripts, videos and exhibits.

 

We have developed a number of technology-based tools to assist our clients in managing complex litigation. TrialMax®, our comprehensive trial preparation software, enables a litigation team to easily store, annotate and display documents, computer graphics, video clips and digitized depositions in the courtroom. We employ an automated tool for handling trial data regardless of information source or data type. Secure Extranet Services is our Internet application for clients that are parties to multi-district litigation.

 

Our Other Financial and Litigation Consulting Practices.    We have recently expanded our consulting services to include regulatory, intellectual property, valuation, mergers and acquisitions advisory, lender and transactional support and dispute settlement services. Our statistical and economic experts in our regulatory practice group use a range of tools to help companies evaluate issues such as the economic impact of deregulation on a particular industry, the amount of commercial damages suffered by a business as a result of a tort or a breach of contract or the value of a business or professional practice. We also work with clients to develop business strategy and tactics on an ongoing basis to address these issues. Our specialists advise clients in the telecommunications, energy and transportation industries in antitrust cases, regulatory proceedings, strategic planning and mergers and acquisitions. Our professionals regularly provide expert testimony on damages, rates and prices, merger benefits and valuations.

 

Our experienced intellectual property professionals provide valuation, damage analysis and expert testimony services. They provide their services to a range of industries, including oil and gas, technology and consumer products. They perform financial analyses of intellectual property in licensing and royalty disputes, antitrust claims and other types of disputes. Our professionals in this group employ industry research, statistical analysis, regression techniques, portfolio analysis and sophisticated financial modeling to support defensible, credible valuation and damage conclusions.

 

Our mergers and acquisitions advisory specialists assist clients in negotiating and structuring business combinations, acquisitions and dispositions of assets, business units or entire businesses. Our lender and transactional support practice group assists lenders and other institutional clients in performing financial due diligence for loans, acquisitions and other transactions.

 

39


Table of Contents

 

Our dispute settlement practice group helps our clients mitigate the cost of, or avoid, litigation by evaluating claims and risks. These professonals coordinate business expertise with legal and technical analysis to develop cost-effective settlement strategies and implement mutually beneficial business resolutions.

 

Our Acquisition of BRS

 

On August 30, 2002, we completed the acquisition of certain assets and liabilities of BRS. The purchase price for BRS consisted of $141.3 million in cash and 3,000,000 shares of our common stock valued at $101.9 million.

 

We believe our acquisition of BRS will provide us with many strategic benefits. The combination has enhanced our position as one of the largest U.S. providers of turnaround, restructuring, bankruptcy and related consulting services. On a combined basis, with over 60 senior managing directors and 450 other professionals and support staff, we believe we can continue to increase our market position in this industry. The BRS acquisition solidifies our national presence and broadens the platform from which we can more quickly handle increasingly larger and more complex consulting engagements.

 

We believe we can successfully integrate BRS into our business. Immediately after the acquisition, BRS began operating as part of our turnaround, restructuring and bankruptcy practice group. We have already integrated the BRS operations into our billing and operations systems. This has allowed our management team to instantly monitor the operating performance of the acquired business at very detailed levels. We have entered into a one-year transition services agreement with PwC to provide various infrastructure-related services. PwC has agreed to provide us with information technology and other services as well as office space while we fully integrate all aspects of BRS’ operations into our business. PwC is providing these transition services to us on the same allocated cost basis as it did when BRS was part of PwC.

 

We made offers to 49 BRS partners, all of whom have agreed to work for us as senior managing directors. Each has entered into a four-year employment agreement with us. When they withdrew as partners of PwC, 47 of them received shares of our common stock from PwC. These partners received a total of about approximately 1.2 million shares of our common stock and then agreed with us to restrict the transfer of 40% of their shares. All restricted shares are non-transferable for two years. After the second anniversary of the closing of the BRS acquisition, one-half of these restricted shares become unrestricted, and on the fourth anniversary, the remaining shares also become unrestricted. As an added incentive to remain with us, we granted the BRS partners contractual protection against a decline in the value of their restricted shares during the four-year restricted period if the market price for the shares falls below $28.33 per share. If a BRS partner were to terminate his or her employment with us prior to the expiration of the four-year term of the employment agreement, the restricted period for the remaining restricted shares would be extended to eight years from the date of termination, and these shares would lose their price protection. Nearly all of the BRS partners and selected other executives that joined us also received options to purchase a total of 602,000 shares of our common stock at the fair market value of our common stock on August 30, 2002. These options vest in equal annual installments over three years beginning one year from the closing of the acquisition.

 

We have entered into a three-year noncompetition arrangement with PwC. During the noncompetition period, PwC has agreed not to provide restructuring, bankruptcy or insolvency services in the U.S. and to limit the fees it receives for providing its audit clients with debtor-side restructuring services in the U.S. to $12.0 million during the first year of the noncompetition period, $15.0 million during the second year and $17.0 million during the third year. PwC also agreed not to market any of its consulting services using the terms “BRS” or “BRS Services.” Our noncompetition arrangement with PwC, however, generally permits non-U.S. PwC firms to provide services in the U.S. that are competitive with BRS’ services in cases where the primary engagement is outside of the U.S. or where the provision of work is required by a statutory or fiduciary obligation.

 

40


Table of Contents

 

Pending Sale of Our Applied Sciences Practice Group

 

Our applied sciences practice group offers a broad range of forensic engineering and scientific investigation services. These services include accident reconstruction, fire investigation, product failure analysis and quality control analysis. In connection with the BRS acquisition, we have decided to sell our applied sciences practice group because the practice is no longer a core part of our business. As of December 31, 2002, we sold a part of the applied sciences practice group for a total consideration of $4.2 million, including a seven year note of $2.0 million. We incurred a loss after taxes of $891,000 in connection with this sale. We expect to complete the sale of the entire applied sciences practice group by the end of 2003. We intend to use the proceeds from the sale to reduce our outstanding debt under our credit facility. However, we cannot assure you that we will be able to sell our entire applied sciences practice group within the stated timeframe or at what price we will be able to sell it. Depending on the sale price and the tax structure of the transaction, the amount realized after taxes from the sale may be less than the carrying value. For the nine months ended September 30, 2002, the applied sciences practice group reported income from operations of discontinued operations, net of income taxes, of $2.8 million.

 

Clients

 

We have cultivated long-term relationships with many of the premier financial institutions, law firms, private equity firms and other institutions in the U.S. In 2001, our most important ongoing clients and sources of referral were 21 of the 25 largest banks located in the U.S. and 68 of the top 100 law firms (based on revenues as reported by American Lawyer magazine).

 

We believe that a very significant percentage of our revenues came from existing clients or referrals from existing clients. Our largest single client represented less than 10% of our total revenues in each of the past three years and for the nine months ended September 30, 2002.

 

Marketing and Sales

 

We rely primarily on referrals and our reputation to market our services to new and existing clients since most of our work is repeat work for existing clients or comes from referrals from existing clients or relationships with partners in major law firms or other professionals. Our professionals develop close working relationships with clients and often learn about new business opportunities from their frequent contacts with clients. We anticipate that the BRS partners will enhance our ability to obtain business through referrals, given their reputations and contacts in our industry. In marketing our services, we emphasize our experience, the quality of our services and our professionals’ particular areas of expertise, as well as our ability to quickly staff a new engagement. While we aggressively seek new business opportunities, we maintain high professional standards and carefully evaluate potential new client relationships and engagements before accepting them.

 

We do not rely on sales personnel to market our consulting services, except in our applied science and trial support practice groups. The applied science practice group has about five full-time sales people, and the trial support practice group has about ten full-time sales people.

 

Competition

 

The industry in which we operate is highly competitive. Our competitors range from large organizations, such as the national accounting firms and the large management consulting companies that offer a broad range of consulting services, to small firms and independent contractors that provide one specialized service. Competitive factors for our services include reputation, size, ability to immediately staff a substantial engagement, performance record, quality of work, range of services provided and existing client relationships. To a lesser extent, we also compete on price, but the critical nature of our services typically reduces price to a secondary consideration.

 

41


Table of Contents

 

Some national service providers are larger than we are and, on any given engagement, may have a competitive advantage over us with respect to one or more competitive factors. The smaller local or regional firms, while not offering the range of services we provide, often are able to provide the lowest price on a specific engagement because of their lower overhead costs and proximity to the engagement.

 

Human Resources

 

At September 30, 2002, we had 766 employees, excluding the 284 employees in our applied sciences practice group. We also maintain consulting arrangements with about 2,300 independent consultants. Most of our professionals have many years of experience in their field of practice, and many are well recognized for their expertise and experience. All 49 BRS partners to whom we made offers accepted our offer, along with 322 BRS professionals and 31 support persons.

 

Properties

 

We lease our principal corporate facility in Annapolis, Maryland, under a lease that expires in February 2007. This facility contains about 16,000 square feet of space. We also lease 32 other offices across the U.S., in cities such as New York, Chicago, Houston, Dallas, Los Angeles and Washington, D.C. 25 of these offices are used by our applied sciences practice group. PwC has agreed that for up to one year after our BRS acquisition, our BRS people may continue to occupy PwC’s offices in New York, Dallas, Los Angeles, Chicago, Atlanta and ten other cities. We are currently negotiating to lease additional facilities to accommodate the addition of the BRS personnel in the cities where they currently work. We intend to relocate them as soon as possible and expect to obtain additional leased facilities on commercially reasonable terms.

 

Litigation

 

We are not currently party to any material litigation. When we acquired BRS, we did not assume any liability for any material litigation or claims related to the BRS business while part of PwC.

 

42


Table of Contents

MANAGEMENT

 

The following are our executive officers and directors:

 

Name


  

Age


  

Positions


Jack B. Dunn, IV

  

51

  

Chairman of the Board and Chief Executive Officer

Stewart J. Kahn

  

58

  

President, Chief Operating Officer and Director

Theodore I. Pincus

  

59

  

Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer

Barry S. Kaufman

  

55

  

Vice President of Operations

Glenn R. Baker

  

61

  

President, Applied Sciences Practice Group

Denis J. Callaghan

  

60

  

Director

James A. Flick, Jr.

  

68

  

Director

Peter F. O’Malley

  

63

  

Director

Dennis J. Shaughnessy

  

55

  

Director

George P. Stamas

  

51

  

Director

 

Jack B. Dunn, IV, became our Chairman of the Board of Directors in December 1998 and has served as our Chief Executive Officer since October 1995. From October 1995 to December 1998, he also served as our President. From May 1994 to October 1995, he served as our Chief Operating Officer. From October 1992 through September 1995, he served as our Chief Financial Officer. Mr. Dunn is a limited partner of the Baltimore Orioles and a director of Aether Systems, Inc. Prior to joining us, he was a member of the Board of Directors and a Managing Director of Legg Mason Wood Walker, Incorporated, a financial services company, and directed its Baltimore corporate finance and investment banking activities.

 

Stewart J. Kahn has served as our President since December 1998 and as our Chief Operating Officer since September 1999. Since 1989, Mr. Kahn has served as President of Kahn Consulting, Inc., a turnaround, restructuring and bankruptcy and forensic accounting practice, which became one of our subsidiaries in September 1998.

 

Theodore I. Pincus has been our Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer since April 1999. Prior to joining us, Mr. Pincus was Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer of Nitinol Medical Technologies from May 1995 to March 1999. Before then, he was President of the Pincus Group, a financial consulting firm, from December 1989 to May 1995.

 

Barry S. Kaufman has been our Vice President of Operations since July 2002. Prior to joining us, Mr. Kaufman was a director and subsequently a partner with Arthur Andersen’s Strategy and Technology practice from February 1998 to June 2002. From August 1997 to February 1998, he was President of his own consulting firm, KTFB. From March 1993 to July 1997 Mr. Kaufman served as a director with Kahn Consulting, Inc., which we acquired in September 1998.

 

Glenn R. Baker has been President of our applied sciences practice group since September 1998. Prior to joining us, he was Chief Executive Officer and President of S.E.A., Inc., which we acquired in September 1998. Mr. Baker co-founded S.E.A., Inc. in 1970.

 

Denis J. Callaghan has been a director of FTI since 2000. Mr. Callaghan retired from Deutsche Bank in February 2000, where he was the Director of North American Equity Research. Prior to becoming Director of Equity Research in 1992, Mr. Callaghan was responsible for Alex. Brown’s Insurance and Financial Services Research Groups.

 

James A. Flick, Jr. has been a director of FTI since 1992. Mr. Flick is President and Chief Executive Officer of Winnow, Inc., a management consulting firm. From 1994 to 2001, Mr. Flick was also Chairman, President and Chief Executive Officer of Dome Corporation, a real estate development and management services company. Mr. Flick is a director of Capital One Financial Corporation.

 

43


Table of Contents

 

Peter F. O’Malley has been a director of FTI since 1992. Mr. O’Malley is President of Aberdeen Creek Corporation, a privately-held company engaged in investment, business consulting and development activities. Mr. O’Malley is a founder of, and since 1989 has been Of Counsel to, the law firm of O’Malley, Miles, Nylen & Gilmore. Mr. O’Malley also is a director of Potomac Electric Power Company and Legg Mason, Inc.

 

Dennis J. Shaughnessy has been a director of FTI since 1992. Since 1989, Mr. Shaughnessy has been a General Partner of Grotech Capital Group, Inc., a venture capital firm. Prior to becoming a General Partner of Grotech Capital Group in 1989, Mr. Shaughnessy was Chief Executive Officer of CRI International, Inc. Mr. Shaughnessy is also a director of TESSCO Technologies, Inc. and U.S. Vision, Inc.

 

George P. Stamas has been a director of FTI since 1992. Since January 2002, Mr. Stamas has been a senior partner of the national law firm of Kirkland & Ellis. Mr. Stamas is also a venture partner of New Enterprise Associates, a venture capital firm, and a director of Aether Systems, Inc. From 1999 to January 2002, Mr. Stamas was vice chairman of the Board of Directors of Deutsche Bank. Mr. Stamas is a limited partner of the Baltimore Orioles, the Washington Capitals and the Washington Wizards. From 1996 to 1999, Mr. Stamas was a partner in the law firm of Wilmer, Cutler & Pickering LLP.

 

44


Table of Contents

DESCRIPTION OF CAPITAL STOCK

 

General

 

As of the date of this prospectus, our authorized capital stock consists of 45,000,000 shares of common stock, $0.01 par value per share, and 5,000,000 shares of preferred stock, $0.01 par value per share. At January 10, 2003, we had 24,110,980 shares of our common stock outstanding and no shares of our preferred stock issued and outstanding.

 

Common Stock

 

Voting Rights.    Holders of our common stock are entitled to one vote per share on all matters submitted to a vote of stockholders generally. Our stockholders have no right to cumulate their votes in the election of directors.

 

Dividend Rights.    Holders of our common stock are entitled to receive dividends and other distributions pro rata when, as and if declared from time to time by our board of directors out of funds legally available for that purpose, subject to preferences that may be applicable should we issue preferred stock. We have never paid cash dividends on our common stock, and we do not intend to pay dividends in the foreseeable future.

 

Rights Upon Liquidation.    If we voluntarily or involuntarily liquidate, dissolve or wind up, the holders of our common stock are entitled to share ratably in all assets remaining after payment of liabilities, including all distributions to holders of preferred stock having a liquidation preference over the common stock.

 

Miscellaneous.    Our charter does not grant the holders of our common stock preemptive or other subscription or conversion rights, and no redemption provisions exist with respect to such shares. All issued and outstanding shares of our common stock are, and the shares to be sold in this offering will be, when issued and paid for, fully paid and non-assessable.

 

Preferred Stock

 

Our charter authorizes our board of directors to issue preferred stock in one or more series, to fix the number of shares constituting such series and the designation of such series, the voting powers, if any, of the shares of such series, the preferences and relative, participating, optional or other special rights, if any, and any qualifications, limitations or restrictions thereof, of the shares of such series. We have not issued any series of preferred stock.

 

Anti-Takeover Provisions of Our Charter and Bylaws

 

Classification of Directors.     Our charter and bylaws provide that our board of directors is divided into three classes serving staggered three-year terms. The classification of directors could prevent a stockholder, or group of stockholders, having majority voting power, from obtaining control of our board until the second annual stockholders’ meeting following the date that the stockholder, or group of stockholders, obtains majority voting power. Thus, this provision may discourage a potential acquiror from making a tender offer or otherwise attempting to obtain control of us.

 

Advance Notice Provisions.     Our bylaws provide that stockholders must provide timely notice in writing to bring business before an annual meeting of stockholders or to nominate candidates for election as directors at an annual meeting of stockholders. The bylaws also specify the form and content of a stockholder’s notice. These provisions may prevent stockholders from bringing matters before an annual meeting of stockholders or from making nominations for directors at an annual meeting of stockholders.

 

45


Table of Contents

 

Anti-Takeover Provisions of the Maryland General Corporation Law

 

Business Combinations.    The Maryland General Corporation Law prohibits specified “business combinations” between a Maryland corporation and an “interested stockholder”. These business combinations include a merger, consolidation, share exchange, an asset transfer or issuance or reclassification of equity securities. Interested stockholders are either:

 

    anyone who beneficially owns 10% or more of the voting power of the outstanding voting shares of the corporation; or

 

    an affiliate or associate of the corporation who was an interested stockholder or an affiliate or an associate of the interested stockholder at any time within the two-year period prior to the date in question.

 

These business combinations are prohibited for five years after the most recent date on which the stockholder became an interested stockholder. Thereafter, in addition to any other vote required by law or the charter or bylaws, any business combination must be recommended by the board of directors of the corporation and approved by the vote of:

 

    at least 80% of the votes entitled to be cast by all holders of the corporation’s voting shares voting as a single group; and

 

    at least 66 2 / 3 % of the votes entitled to be cast by all holders of the corporation’s voting shares other than voting shares held by the interested stockholder or an affiliate or associate of the interested stockholder.

 

An interested stockholder may avoid complying with these special voting requirements if the interested stockholder pays the corporation’s stockholders a minimum price for their shares (as specified in the statute) and the consideration is received in cash or in the same form previously paid by the interested stockholder for its shares.

 

The business combination statute does not apply to business combinations that are approved or exempted by the corporation’s board of directors prior to the time that the interested stockholder becomes an interested stockholder. A Maryland corporation may also adopt an amendment to its charter electing not to be subject to these special voting requirements. Any amendment would have to be approved by at least 80% of the votes entitled to be cast by all holders of outstanding shares of voting stock voting as a class and 66 2/3% of the votes entitled to be cast by holders of outstanding shares of voting stock who are not interested stockholders. If passed, the amendment will not become effective until 18 months after the corporation’s stockholders voted on it. Any interested stockholders who become an interested stockholder before the adoption of an amendment will not receive relief from the requirements of the statute by the adoption of a charter amendment. We have elected to be generally subject to this statute.

 

Control Share Acquisitions.    The Maryland General Corporation Law provides that “control shares” of a Maryland corporation acquired in a “control share acquisition” have no voting rights other than those voting rights approved by a vote of two-thirds of the votes entitled to be cast on the matter, excluding shares owned by the acquiror or by the corporation’s officers or directors who are employees of the corporation. Control shares are shares of voting stock which, if aggregated with all other shares of stock previously acquired, would entitle the acquiror to exercise voting power in electing directors within any one of the following ranges of voting power:

 

    10% or more but less than 33 1 / 3 % of all voting power;

 

    33 1 / 3 % or more but less than a majority of all voting power; or

 

    a majority or more of all voting power.

 

Control shares do not include shares of stock an acquiring person is entitled to vote as a result of having previously obtained stockholder approval. A control share acquisition generally means the acquisition of, ownership of or the power to direct the exercise of voting power with respect to, control shares.

 

46


Table of Contents

 

An acquiring person may require the board of directors to call a special stockholders’ meeting to consider the voting rights of the shares, but only if the acquiring person made or proposes to make a “control share acquisition,” under specified conditions, including an undertaking to pay expenses. The special stockholders’ meeting must be held within fifty days of the acquiring person’s demand. If no request for a meeting is made, the corporation may itself present the question at any stockholders’ meeting.

 

If voting rights are not approved at the meeting or if the acquiring person does not deliver an acquiring person statement as permitted by the statute, the corporation generally may redeem any or all of the control shares, except those control shares for which stockholders have previously approved voting rights. This redemption of shares must be for fair value, determined without regard to voting rights as of the date of the last control share acquisition or of any stockholders’ meeting at which the voting rights of the shares are considered and not approved. If voting rights for “control shares” are approved at a stockholders’ meeting and the acquiror becomes entitled to vote at least a majority of all shares entitled to vote, all other stockholders may exercise appraisal rights. The fair value of the stock determined for purposes of appraisal rights may not be less than the highest price per share paid in the control share acquisition. The limitations and restrictions otherwise applicable to the exercise of dissenters’ rights do not apply in the context of a “control share acquisition.”

 

The control share acquisition statute does not apply to stock acquired in a merger, consolidation or share exchange if the corporation is a party to the transaction, or to acquisitions previously approved or exempted by a provision in the charter or bylaws of the corporation. We have elected to be generally subject to this statute.

 

Transfer Agent and Registrar

 

The transfer agent and registrar for our common stock is American Stock Transfer & Trust Company.

 

47


Table of Contents

PRINCIPAL AND SELLING STOCKHOLDERS

 

The following table shows the beneficial ownership of our common stock at January 10, 2003:

 

    each stockholder that we know beneficially owns more than 5% of our common stock;

 

    each of our current executive officers and directors; and

 

    all of our current executive officers and directors as a group.

 

The table also shows the number of shares being sold by each selling stockholder and the number and percentage of our outstanding shares each selling stockholder will own after this offering.

 

    

Before Offering


    

Shares Offered


  

After Offering


 

Name of Beneficial Owner (1)(2)


  

Shares


  

Percent(3)


       

Shares


  

Percent(3)


 

Executive Officers and Directors:

                            

Jack B. Dunn, IV (4)

  

335,353

  

1.38

%

  

  

335,353

  

1.27

%

Stewart J. Kahn (5)

  

158,292

  

*

 

  

  

158,292

  

*

 

Theodore I. Pincus (6)

  

45,500

  

*

 

  

  

45,500

  

*

 

Barry S. Kaufman (7)

  

2,000

  

*

 

  

  

2,000

  

*

 

Glenn R. Baker (8)

  

7,500

  

*

 

  

  

7,500

  

*

 

Denis J. Callaghan (9)

  

38,550

  

*

 

  

  

38,550

  

*

 

James A. Flick, Jr. (10)

  

61,847

  

*

 

  

  

61,847

  

*

 

Peter F. O’Malley (11)

  

5,000

  

*

 

  

  

5,000

  

*

 

Dennis J. Shaughnessy (12)

  

3,750

  

*

 

  

  

3,750

  

*

 

George P. Stamas (13)

  

6,909

  

*

 

  

  

6,909

  

*

 

All executive officers and directors as a group (10 persons)

  

664,701

  

2.71

 

  

  

664,701

  

2.49

 

Selling Stockholders:

                            

Edward Bartko (14)

  

26,615

  

*

 

  

15,969

  

10,646

  

*

 

Kevin Regan (15)

  

17,196

  

*

 

  

6,000

  

11,196

  

*

 

Other Stockholders:

                            

Wasatch Advisors, Inc. (16)

  

1,692,439

  

7.02

 

  

  

1,692,439

  

6.46

 


 * Less than 1%.
(1) Unless otherwise specified, the address of these persons is c/o FTI Consulting, Inc., 900 Bestgate Road, Suite 100, Annapolis, Maryland 21401.
(2) We use the SEC’s definition of beneficial ownership. This means that the persons named in this table have sole or shared voting and/or investment power over the shares shown. Beneficial ownership also includes shares underlying options currently exercisable or exercisable within 60 days.
(3) Percentages based on 24,110,980 shares outstanding as of January 10, 2003 before the offering and 26,210,980 shares outstanding after the offering. In the case of shares issuable upon the exercise of options, this percentage assumes the issuance of shares by the holder, but not the exercise of options held by any other holder.
(4) Includes 82,316 shares of common stock and 240,737 shares of common stock issuable upon the exercise of options. Includes 12,000 shares of common stock over which Mr. Dunn and his wife share voting and investment power and includes 300 shares over which Mr. Dunn and his son share voting and investment power. Further, Mr. Dunn has additional options exercisable for 270,000 shares of common stock that have not vested.
(5) Includes 78,292 shares of our common stock and 80,000 shares of our common stock issuable upon exercise of stock options. Further, Mr. Kahn has additional options exercisable for 197,500 shares of common stock that have not vested.

 

48


Table of Contents
(6) Includes 3,000 shares of our common stock and 42,500 shares of our common stock issuable upon exercise of stock options. Further, Mr. Pincus has additional options exercisable for 122,500 shares of common stock that have not vested.
(7) Includes 1,000 shares of our common stock and 1,000 shares of our common stock held in a trust for which Mr. Kaufman is a contingent trustee and beneficiary. Mr. Kaufman’s wife is the trustee of the trust.
(8) Represents 7,500 shares of our common stock issuable upon exercise of stock options.
(9) Includes 8,550 shares of our common stock and 30,000 shares of our common stock issuable upon exercise of stock options.
(10) Includes 11,597 shares of our common stock and 48,750 shares of our common stock issuable upon exercise of stock options. Includes 1,500 shares of our common stock owned by Mr. Flick’s wife.
(11) Represents 5,000 shares of our common stock.
(12) Represents 3,750 shares of our common stock.
(13) Includes 1,909 shares of our common stock over which Mr. Stamas and his wife share voting and investment power and 5,000 shares of our common stock issuable upon exercise of stock options.
(14) Represents 26,615 shares of our common stock. Mr. Bartko is one of our senior managing directors.
(15) Represents 17,196 shares of our common stock. Mr. Regan is one of our senior managing directors.
(16) Wasatch Advisors, Inc.’s address is Social Hall Avenue, Salt Lake City, Utah 84111. Information is based on a Schedule 13G filed with the SEC on February 14, 2002.

 

49


Table of Contents

CERTAIN UNITED STATES TAX CONSEQUENCES TO NON-U.S. HOLDERS

 

The following summary describes the material U.S. federal income and estate tax consequences of the ownership of common stock by a non-U.S. holder (as defined below) as of the date hereof. This discussion does not address all aspects of U.S. federal income and estate taxes and does not deal with foreign, state and local tax consequences that may be relevant to such non-U.S. holders in light of their personal circumstances. Special rules may apply to certain non-U.S. holders, such as certain U.S. expatriates, “controlled foreign corporations”, “passive foreign investment companies”, “foreign personal holding companies” and corporations that accumulate earnings to avoid U.S. federal income tax, that are subject to special treatment under the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended (the “Code”). Such entities should consult their own tax advisors to determine the U.S. federal, state, local and other tax consequences that may be relevant to them. Furthermore, the discussion below is based upon the provisions of the Code, and regulations, rulings and judicial decisions thereunder as of the date hereof, and such authorities may be repealed, revoked or modified so as to result in U.S. federal income tax consequences different from those discussed below. Persons considering the purchase, ownership or disposition of common stock should consult their own tax advisors concerning the U.S. federal income tax consequences in light of their particular situations as well as any consequences arising under the laws of any other taxing jurisdiction.

 

As used herein, a “U.S. holder” of common stock means a holder that is:

 

    a citizen or resident of the U.S.;

 

    a corporation or other business entity taxable as a corporation created or organized in or under the laws of the U.S. or any political subdivision thereof;

 

    an estate the income of which is subject to U.S. federal income taxation regardless of its source; or

 

    a trust if it (x) is subject to the primary supervision of a court within the U.S. and one or more U.S. persons have the authority to control all substantial decisions of the trust or (y) has a valid election in effect under applicable U.S. Treasury regulations to be treated as a U.S. person.

 

A “non-U.S. holder” is a holder that is not a U.S. holder.

 

If a partnership holds common stock, the tax treatment of a partner will generally depend on the status of the partner and the activities of the partnership. If you are a partner of a partnership holding common stock, you should consult your tax advisor.

 

Dividends

 

Dividends paid to you generally will be subject to withholding of U.S. federal income tax at a 30% rate or such lower rate as may be specified by an applicable income tax treaty. However, dividends that are effectively connected with the conduct of a trade or business by you within the U.S. and, where a tax treaty applies, are attributable to a U.S. permanent establishment, are not subject to the withholding tax, but instead are subject to U.S. federal income tax on a net income basis at applicable graduated individual or corporate rates. You must comply with certain certification and disclosure requirements in order for effectively connected income to be exempt from withholding. Any such effectively connected dividends received by a foreign corporation may, under certain circumstances, be subject to an additional “branch profits tax” at a 30% rate or such lower rate as may be specified by an applicable income tax treaty.

 

If you wish to claim the benefit of an applicable treaty rate (and/or avoid back-up withholding as discussed below) for dividends, you will be required to (a) complete Internal Revenue Service (“IRS”) Form W-8BEN (or successor form) and certify under penalty of perjury that, among other things, you are not a U.S. person or (b) if your common stock is held through certain foreign intermediaries, satisfy the relevant certification requirements of applicable Treasury regulations. Special certification and other requirements apply to certain non-U.S. holders that are entities rather than individuals.

 

50


Table of Contents

 

If you are eligible for a reduced rate of U.S. withholding tax pursuant to an income tax treaty, you may obtain a refund of any excess amounts withheld by filing an appropriate claim for refund with the IRS.

 

Gain on Disposition of Common Stock

 

You generally will not be subject to U.S. federal income tax with respect to gain recognized on a sale or other disposition of common stock unless (i) the gain is effectively connected with your trade or business in the U.S., and, where a tax treaty applies, is attributable to your U.S. permanent establishment, (ii) if you are an individual who holds the common stock as a capital asset, you are present in the U.S. for 183 or more days in the taxable year of the sale or other disposition and certain other conditions are met, or (iii) we are or have been a “U.S. real property holding corporation” for U.S. federal income tax purposes.

 

An individual non-U.S. holder described in clause (i) above will be subject to tax on the net gain derived from the sale under regular graduated U.S. federal income tax rates. An individual non-U.S. holder described in clause (ii) above will be subject to a flat 30% tax on the gain derived from the sale, which may be offset by U.S. source capital losses (even though the individual is not considered a resident of the U.S.). If a non-U.S. holder that is a foreign corporation falls under clause (i) above, it will be subject to tax on its gain under regular graduated U.S. federal income tax rates and, in addition, may be subject to the branch profits tax equal to 30% of its effectively connected earnings and profits or at such lower rate as may be specified by an applicable income tax treaty.

 

We believe we are not and do not anticipate becoming a “United States real property holding corporation” for U.S. federal income tax purposes.

 

Federal Estate Tax

 

Common stock held by an individual non-U.S. holder at the time of death will be included in such holder’s gross estate for U.S. federal estate tax purposes, unless an applicable estate tax treaty provides otherwise.

 

Information Reporting and Backup Withholding

 

We must report annually to the IRS and to you the amount of dividends paid to you and the tax withheld with respect to such dividends, regardless of whether withholding was required. Copies of the information returns reporting such dividends and withholding may also be made available to the tax authorities in the country in which you reside under the provisions of an applicable income tax treaty.

 

You will be subject to backup withholding unless applicable certification requirements are met.

 

Payment of the proceeds of a sale of common stock within the U.S. or conducted through certain U.S. related financial intermediaries is subject to both backup withholding and information reporting unless the beneficial owner certifies under penalties of perjury that it is a non-U.S. holder (and the payor does not have actual knowledge that the beneficial owner is a U.S. person) or the holder otherwise establishes an exemption.

 

Any amounts withheld under the backup withholding rules may be allowed as a refund or a credit against such holder’s U.S. federal income tax liability provided the required information is furnished to the IRS.

 

51


Table of Contents

UNDERWRITING

 

Under the terms of an underwriting agreement, that will be filed as an exhibit to the registration statement relating to this prospectus, each of the underwriters named below, for whom Lehman Brothers Inc., Banc of America Securities LLC, Adams, Harkness & Hill, Inc., Janney Montgomery Scott LLC and SunTrust Capital Markets, Inc. are acting as representatives, has agreed to purchase from us and the selling stockholders the respective number of shares of common stock shown opposite its name below. Subject to the terms and conditions of the underwriting agreement, the underwriters are obligated to purchase all of the shares to which they initially committed to purchase (other than those covered by the over-allotment option described below) if they purchase any of the shares.

 

Underwriters


  

Number of

Shares


Lehman Brothers Inc.

    

Banc of America Securities LLC

    

Adams, Harkness & Hill, Inc.

    

Janney Montgomery Scott LLC

    

SunTrust Capital Markets, Inc.

    
    

Total

  

2,121,969

    

 

The underwriting agreement provides that the underwriters’ obligations to purchase our common stock depend upon our satisfaction of the conditions contained in the underwriting agreement, which include:

 

    the representations and warranties made by us to the underwriters in the underwriting agreement being true;

 

    that no material change occurs in the financial markets; and

 

    our delivery of customary closing documents to the underwriters.

 

Commissions and Expenses

 

The public offering price for the shares of common stock in this offering will be set based on the last reported sale price of our common stock on the New York Stock Exchange immediately prior to the pricing of the offering or at a discount to this price. This price is presented on the cover page of this prospectus. The representatives have advised us that the underwriters propose to offer the common stock directly to the public at the public offering price presented on the cover page of this prospectus, and to selected dealers, that may include the underwriters, at the public offering price less a selling concession not in excess of $            per share. The underwriters may allow, and the selected dealers may reallow, a concession not in excess of $            per share to brokers and dealers. After the offering, the underwriters may change the offering price and other selling terms.

 

The following table summarizes the underwriting discounts and commissions we and the selling stockholders will pay. The underwriting discounts and commissions are equal to the public offering price per share, less the amount paid to us per share. The underwriting discounts and commissions equal        % of the initial public offering price.

 

           

Total


    

Per Share


    

Without Over-Allotment


    

With

Over-Allotment


Underwriting discounts and commissions to be paid by us

  

$

 

    

$

 

    

$

 

Underwriting discounts and commissions to be paid by the selling stockholders

                        

 

52


Table of Contents

 

We estimate that the total expenses of the offering payable by us, including registration, filing and listing fees, printing fees, legal and accounting fees and other fees and expenses, excluding underwriting discounts and commissions, will be approximately $1.0 million. We have agreed to pay the expenses incurred by the selling stockholders in connection with the offering, other than the underwriting discounts and commissions applicable to the shares they are selling.

 

Over-Allotment Option

 

We have granted to the underwriters an option to purchase up to an aggregate of 318,295 shares of our common stock, exercisable to cover over-allotments, if any, at the public offering price less the underwriting discounts and commissions shown on the cover page of this prospectus. The underwriters may exercise this option at any time until 30 days after the date of the underwriting agreement. To the extent the underwriters exercise this option, each underwriter will be committed, so long as the conditions of the underwriting agreement are satisfied, to purchase a number of additional shares proportionate to that underwriter’s initial commitment as indicated in the preceding table.

 

Lock-up Agreements

 

We have agreed that, without the prior written consent of Lehman Brothers Inc., we will not, directly or indirectly, offer, sell or dispose of any shares of our common stock or any securities that may be converted into or exchanged for any common stock for a period of 90 days from the date of this prospectus. In addition, all of our executive officers, except Glenn R. Baker, and all of our directors and each selling stockholder have agreed under lock-up agreements not to, without the prior written consent of Lehman Brothers Inc., directly or indirectly, offer, sell or otherwise dispose of any shares of our common stock or any securities that may be converted into or exchanged or exercised for any common stock for a period of 90 days from the date of this prospectus. Our executive officers and directors, however, may sell or otherwise dispose of an aggregate of 200,000 of their shares without the prior written consent of Lehman Brothers if the closing sale price of our common stock exceeds 110% of the offering price specified on the front cover page of this prospectus on any trading date at least 30 days after the date of this prospectus. As of the date of this prospectus, these individuals beneficially own an aggregate of 657,201 shares of our common stock. Mr. Baker beneficially owns options exercisable for 7,500 shares of our common stock.

 

Indemnification

 

We and the selling stockholders have agreed to indemnify the underwriters against liabilities relating to the offering, including liabilities under the Securities Act, and to contribute to payments that the underwriters may be required to make for these liabilities.

 

Stabilization, Short Positions and Penalty Bids

 

The representatives may engage in over-allotment, stabilizing transactions, syndicate short covering transactions, and penalty bids or purchases for the purpose of pegging, fixing or maintaining the price of the common stock, in accordance with Regulation M under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934:

 

    Over-allotment involves sales by the underwriters of shares in excess of the number of shares the underwriters are obligated to purchase, which creates a syndicate short position. The short position may be either a covered short position or a naked short position. In a covered short position, the number of shares over-allotted by the underwriters is not greater than the number of shares that they may purchase in the over-allotment option. In a naked short position, the number of shares involved is greater than the number of shares in the over-allotment option. The underwriters may close out any short position by either exercising their over-allotment option, in whole or in part, or purchasing shares in the open market.

 

53


Table of Contents

 

    Stabilizing transactions permit bidders to purchase the underlying security so long as the stabilizing bids do not exceed a specified maximum.

 

    Syndicate short covering transactions involve purchases of the common stock in the open market after the distribution has been completed in order to cover syndicate short positions. In determining the source of shares to close out the short position, the underwriters will consider, among other things, the price of shares available for purchase in the open market as compared to the price at which they may purchase shares through the over-allotment option. If the underwriters create a naked short position, the position can only be closed out by buying shares in the open market. A naked short position is more likely to be created if the underwriters are concerned that there could be downward pressure on the price of the shares in the open market after pricing that could adversely affect investors who purchase in the offering.

 

    Penalty bids permit the representatives to reclaim a selling concession from a syndicate member when the common stock originally sold by the syndicate member is purchased in a stabilizing or syndicate covering transaction to cover syndicate short positions.

 

These stabilizing transactions, syndicate covering transactions and penalty bids may have the effect of raising or maintaining the market price of our common stock or preventing or retarding a decline in the market price of our common stock. As a result, the price of our common stock may be higher than the price that might otherwise exist in the open market. These transactions may be effected on the New York Stock Exchange or otherwise and, if commenced, may be discontinued at any time.

 

Neither we nor any of the underwriters make any representation or prediction as to the direction or magnitude of any effect that the transactions described above may have on the price of our common stock. In addition, neither we nor any of the underwriters make any representation that the underwriters will engage in these stabilizing transactions or that any transaction, once commenced, will not be discontinued without notice.

 

Stamp Taxes

 

Purchasers of the shares of our common stock offered by this prospectus may be required to pay stamp taxes and other charges under the laws and practices of the country of purchase, in addition to the offering price listed on the cover of this prospectus.

 

Notice to Canadian Residents

 

Resale Restrictions

 

The distribution of the securities in Canada is being made only on a private placement basis exempt from the requirement that we prepare and file a prospectus with the securities regulatory authorities in each province where trades of securities are made. Any resale of the securities in Canada must be made under applicable securities laws which will vary depending on the relevant jurisdiction, and which may require resales to be made under available statutory exemptions or under a discretionary exemption granted by the applicable Canadian securities regulatory authority. Purchasers are advised to seek legal advice prior to any resale of the securities.

 

Representations of Purchasers

 

By purchasing securities in Canada and accepting a purchase confirmation a purchaser is representing to us and the dealer from whom the purchase confirmation is received that;

 

    the purchaser is entitled under applicable provincial securities laws to purchase the securities without the benefit of a prospectus qualified under those securities laws;

 

    where required by law, that the purchaser is purchasing as principal and not as agent; and

 

54


Table of Contents

 

    the purchaser has reviewed the text above under “Resale Restrictions”.

 

Rights of Actions—Ontario Purchasers

 

Under Ontario securities legislation, a purchaser who purchases a security offered by this prospectus during the period of distribution will have a statutory right of action for damages, or while still the owner of the shares, for rescission against us in the event that this prospectus contains a misrepresentation. A purchaser will be deemed to have relied on the misrepresentation. The right of action for damages is exercisable not later than the earlier of 180 days from the date the purchaser first had knowledge of the facts giving rise to the cause of action and three years from the date on which payment is made for the shares. The right of action for rescission is exercisable not later than 180 days from the date on which payment is made for the shares. If a purchaser elects to exercise the right of action for rescission, the purchaser will have no right of action for damages against us. In no case will the amount recoverable in any action exceed the price at which the shares were offered to the purchaser and if the purchaser is shown to have purchased the securities with knowledge of the misrepresentation, we will have no liability. In the case of an action for damages, we will not be liable for all or any portion of the damages that are proven to not represent the depreciation in value of the shares as a result of the misrepresentation relied upon. These rights are in addition to, and without derogation from, any other rights or remedies available at law to an Ontario purchaser. The foregoing is a summary of the rights available to an Ontario purchaser. Ontario purchasers should refer to the complete text of the relevant statutory provisions.

 

Enforcement of Legal Rights

 

All of our directors and officers as well as the experts named herein may be located outside of Canada and, as a result, it may not be possible for Canadian purchasers to effect service of process within Canada upon us or those persons. All or a substantial portion of our assets and the assets of those persons may be located outside of Canada and, as a result, it may not be possible to satisfy a judgment against us or those persons in Canada or to enforce a judgment obtained in Canadian courts against us or those persons outside of Canada.

 

Taxation and Eligibility for Investment

 

Canadian purchasers of securities should consult their own legal and tax advisors with respect to the tax consequences of an investment in the securities in their particular circumstances and about the eligibility of the securities for investment by the purchaser under relevant Canadian legislation.

 

Electronic Distribution

 

A prospectus in electronic format may be made available on the Internet sites or through other online services maintained by one or more of the underwriters and/or selling group members participating in this offering, or by their affiliates. In those cases, prospective investors may view offering terms online and, depending upon the particular underwriter or selling group member, prospective investors may be allowed to place orders online. The underwriters may agree with us to allocate a specific number of shares for sale to online brokerage account holders. Any such allocation for online distributions will be made by the underwriters on the same basis as other allocations.

 

Other than the prospectus in electronic format, the information on any underwriter’s or selling group member’s website and any information contained in any other website maintained by an underwriter or selling group member is not part of this prospectus or the registration statement of which this prospectus forms a part, has not been approved and/or endorsed by us or any underwriter or selling group member in its capacity as underwriter or selling group member and should not be relied upon by investors.

 

Listing

 

Our common stock is listed on the New York Stock Exchange under the symbol “FCN.”

 

55


Table of Contents

 

NASD Conduct Rule

 

This offering is being conducted pursuant to NASD Conduct Rule 2710(c)(8) because more than ten percent of the proceeds of this offering are being directed to affiliates of underwriters of this offering. No qualified independent underwriter is required for this offering because there is a bona fide independent market for our common stock.

 

Our Relationships with Underwriters

 

Some of the underwriters or their affiliates have provided investment banking and financial advisory services for us from time to time, for which they have received customary fees and reimbursements of expenses, and they may in the future provide additional services. In particular, Lehman Brothers Inc., one of the representatives, acted as our financial advisor and rendered a fairness opinion, for which it received fees of $500,000, in connection with our acquisition of BRS from PwC. Banc of America Securities LLC, one of the representatives, acted as the sole lead arranger and sole book manager under both our old and new credit facilities. Bank of America, N.A., an affiliate of Banc of America Securities LLC, acted as the administrative agent and as a lender under our old credit facility, and as the administrative agent, swing line lender and letter of credit issuer under our new credit facility, for which it has received fees from us totaling approximately $3.3 million. SunTrust Bank, an affiliate of SunTrust Capital Markets, Inc., one of the underwriters of the offering, acted as documentation agent and as a lender under our old credit agreement and as a lender under our new credit agreement, for which it has received fees from us totaling approximately $647,000. Bank of America, N.A. and SunTrust Bank, as lenders, will receive 49% and 15%, respectively, of any repayment of indebtedness outstanding under our new credit facility from the net proceeds we receive from this offering.

 

56


Table of Contents

LEGAL MATTERS

 

The validity of our common stock offered by this prospectus will be passed upon for us by Piper Rudnick LLP, Baltimore, Maryland. Piper Rudnick LLP provides legal services to us on an ongoing basis. Certain legal matters will be passed upon for the underwriters by Simpson Thacher & Bartlett, Palo Alto, California.

 

EXPERTS

 

Ernst & Young LLP, independent auditors, have audited our consolidated financial statements and schedule at December 31, 2000 and 2001, and for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2001, as set forth in their reports. We have included our consolidated financial statements and schedule in this prospectus and elsewhere in the registration statement in reliance on Ernst & Young LLP’s reports given on their authority as experts in accounting and auditing.

 

The financial statements of BRS at June 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002, and for each of the three years in the period ended June 30, 2002 included in this prospectus have been audited by Deloitte & Touche LLP, independent auditors, as stated in their report appearing herein and is included in reliance upon the reports of such firm given upon their authority as experts in accounting and auditing.

 

WHERE YOU CAN FIND MORE INFORMATION

 

We have filed with the SEC under the Securities Act a registration statement on Form S-3 with respect to the common stock offered under this prospectus. This prospectus does not contain all of the information contained in the registration statement, certain portions of which have been omitted under the rules of the SEC. We also file annual, quarterly and current reports, proxy statements and other information with the SEC under the Exchange Act. The Exchange Act file number for our SEC filings is 001-14875. You may read and copy the registration statement and any other document we file at the following SEC public reference room: Judiciary Plaza, 450 Fifth Street, N.W., Rm. 1024, Washington, D.C. 20549.

 

You may obtain information on the operation of the public reference room in Washington, D.C. by calling the SEC at 1-800-SEC-0330. We file information electronically with the SEC. Our SEC filings are available from the SEC’s Internet site at http://www.sec.gov, which contains reports, proxy and information statements and other information regarding issuers that file electronically.

 

57


Table of Contents

INCORPORATION BY REFERENCE

 

The SEC allows us to “incorporate by reference” the documents we file with it, which means that we can disclose important information to you by referring you to those documents. The information incorporated by reference is considered to be part of this prospectus, and information in documents that we file later with the SEC will automatically update and supersede information in this prospectus. We incorporate by reference the documents listed below and any future filings we will make with the SEC under Sections 13(a), 13(c), 14 or 15(d) of the Exchange Act until the completion of the offering contemplated by this prospectus:

 

    Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2001, including the information incorporated by reference therein (as amended by a Form 10-K/A filed on November 20, 2002);

 

    Quarterly Reports on Form 10-Q for the quarters ended March 31, 2002, June 30, 2002 and September 30, 2002;

 

    Current Reports on Form 8-K filed on July 26, 2002 and September 13, 2002 (as amended by a  Form 8-K/A filed on October 9, 2002); and

 

    The description of our common stock which is contained in filings we have made under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, including all amendments or reports we have filed for the purpose of updating this description.

 


 

We furnish our stockholders with annual reports that contain audited financial statements and quarterly reports for the first three quarters of each year that contain unaudited interim financial information. You may obtain copies of our filings, at no cost, by writing to us at: FTI Consulting, Inc., 900 Bestgate Road, Suite 100, Annapolis, Maryland 21401, Attention: Investor Relations.

 

58


Table of Contents

 

INDEX TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

 

    

Page


Consolidated Financial Statements of FTI Consulting, Inc.:

    

Report of Independent Auditors

  

F-2

Consolidated Balance Sheets at December 31, 2000 and 2001 and September 30, 2002 (unaudited)

  

F-3

Consolidated Statements of Income for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2001 and for the nine months ended September 30, 2001 and 2002 (unaudited)

  

F-4

Consolidated Statements of Stockholders’ Equity for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2001 and for the nine months ended September 30, 2002 (unaudited)

  

F-5

Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2001 and for the nine months ended September 30, 2001 and 2002 (unaudited)

  

F-7

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

  

F-8

Financial Statements of PricewaterhouseCoopers Business Recovery Services Excluding its Broker/Dealer Activities:

    

Independent Auditors’ Report

  

F-24

Statements of Assets and Liabilities at June 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002

  

F-25

Income Statements Before Partner Distributions and Benefits for each of the three years in the period ended June 30, 2002

  

F-26

Statements of Cash Flows for each of the three years in the period ended June 30, 2002

  

F-27

Statements of Changes in PwC U.S. Investment for each of the three years in the period ended June 30, 2002

  

F-28

Notes to Financial Statements

  

F-29

 

F-1


Table of Contents

REPORT OF INDEPENDENT AUDITORS

 

Board of Directors and Stockholders

FTI Consulting, Inc.

 

We have audited the accompanying consolidated balance sheets of FTI Consulting, Inc. and subsidiaries as of December 31, 2000 and 2001, and the related consolidated statements of income, stockholders’ equity, and cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2001. These financial statements are the responsibility of the Company’s management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these financial statements based on our audits.

 

We conducted our audits in accordance with auditing standards generally accepted in the United States. Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. An audit also includes assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall financial statement presentation. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.

 

In our opinion, the consolidated financial statements referred to above present fairly, in all material respects, the consolidated financial position of FTI Consulting, Inc. and subsidiaries as of December 31, 2000 and 2001, and the consolidated results of their operations and their cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2001, in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States.

 

/S/    ERNST & YOUNG LLP

 

Baltimore, Maryland

November 12, 2002

 

F-2


Table of Contents

 

FTI CONSULTING, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

 

CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEETS

 

    

December 31,


    

September 30,

2002


 
    

2000


    

2001


    
           

(unaudited)

 
    

(dollars in thousands)

 

Assets

                          

Current assets:

                          

Cash and cash equivalents

  

$

3,235

 

  

$

12,856

 

  

$

3,618

 

Accounts receivable, less allowance of $928 in 2000, $1,088 in 2001 and $6,580 in 2002

  

 

12,146

 

  

 

12,094

 

  

 

28,662

 

Unbilled receivables, less allowance of $680 in 2000, $682 in 2001 and $3,731 in 2002

  

 

12,226

 

  

 

13,675

 

  

 

41,091

 

Income taxes recoverable

  

 

1,317

 

  

 

1,790

 

  

 

—  

 

Deferred income taxes

  

 

648

 

  

 

941

 

  

 

941

 

Prepaid expenses and other current assets

  

 

1,627

 

  

 

2,069

 

  

 

2,728

 

Current assets of discontinued operations

  

 

11,753

 

  

 

12,241

 

  

 

12,625

 

    


  


  


Total current assets

  

 

42,952

 

  

 

55,666

 

  

 

89,665

 

Property and equipment:

                          

Furniture, equipment and software

  

 

17,520

 

  

 

15,594

 

  

 

20,496

 

Leasehold improvements

  

 

4,389

 

  

 

3,863

 

  

 

4,157

 

    


  


  


    

 

21,909

 

  

 

19,457

 

  

 

24,653

 

Accumulated depreciation and amortization

  

 

(10,177

)

  

 

(8,838

)

  

 

(11,335

)

    


  


  


    

 

11,732

 

  

 

10,619

 

  

 

13,318

 

Deferred income taxes

  

 

—  

 

  

 

150

 

  

 

150

 

Goodwill

  

 

77,253

 

  

 

75,733

 

  

 

318,228

 

Other intangible assets, net of accumulated amortization of $252 in 2002

  

 

—  

 

  

 

—  

 

  

 

4,738

 

Other assets

  

 

1,168

 

  

 

873

 

  

 

4,940

 

Long-term assets of discontinued operations

  

 

16,141

 

  

 

16,057

 

  

 

15,976

 

    


  


  


Total assets

  

$

149,246

 

  

$

159,098

 

  

$

447,015

 

    


  


  


Liabilities and stockholders’ equity

                          

Current liabilities:

                          

Accounts payable and accrued expenses

  

$

4,325

 

  

$

4,788

 

  

$

5,502

 

Accrued compensation expense

  

 

10,339

 

  

 

12,536

 

  

 

18,825

 

Income taxes payable

  

 

—  

 

  

 

—  

 

  

 

1,499

 

Deferred income taxes

  

 

500

 

  

 

130

 

  

 

130

 

Current portion of long-term debt

  

 

4,333

 

  

 

4,333

 

  

 

16,083

 

Billings in excess of services provided

  

 

3,115

 

  

 

4,745

 

  

 

32,143

 

Other current liabilities

  

 

177

 

  

 

368

 

  

 

434

 

    


  


  


Total current liabilities

  

 

22,789

 

  

 

26,900

 

  

 

74,616

 

Long-term debt, less current portion

  

 

56,167

 

  

 

23,833

 

  

 

122,833

 

Other long-term liabilities

  

 

600

 

  

 

1,481

 

  

 

1,613

 

Deferred income taxes

  

 

1,066

 

  

 

1,748

 

  

 

1,748

 

Commitments and contingent liabilities

  

 

—  

 

  

 

—  

 

  

 

—  

 

Stockholders’ equity:

                          

Preferred stock, $.01 par value; 5,000,000 shares authorized, none outstanding

  

 

—  

 

  

 

—  

 

  

 

—  

 

Common stock, $.01 par value; 45,000,000 shares authorized; 15,851,168, 19,590,938 and 23,713,055 shares issued and outstanding in 2000, 2001 and 2002, respectively

  

 

159

 

  

 

196

 

  

 

237

 

Additional paid-in capital

  

 

53,898

 

  

 

75,416

 

  

 

193,997

 

Unearned compensation

  

 

—  

 

  

 

(568

)

  

 

(411

)

Retained earnings

  

 

14,567

 

  

 

31,036

 

  

 

53,220

 

Accumulated other comprehensive income (loss)

  

 

—  

 

  

 

(944

)

  

 

(838

)

    


  


  


Total stockholders’ equity

  

 

68,624

 

  

 

105,136

 

  

 

246,205

 

    


  


  


Total liabilities and stockholders’ equity

  

$

149,246

 

  

$

159,098

 

  

$

447,015

 

    


  


  


 

See accompanying notes.

 

F-3


Table of Contents

FTI CONSULTING, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

 

CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF INCOME

 

         

Year ended December 31,


    

Nine months

ended September 30,


 
         

1999


    

2000


    

2001


    

2001


    

2002


 

Revenues

       

$

48,914

 

  

$

95,532

 

  

$

122,317

 

  

$

91,826

 

  

$

133,556

 

Direct cost of revenues

       

 

25,600

 

  

 

48,979

 

  

 

59,074

 

  

 

46,704

 

  

 

65,512

 

Selling, general and administrative expenses

       

 

16,532

 

  

 

23,920

 

  

 

33,085

 

  

 

23,608

 

  

 

32,796

 

Amortization of goodwill and other intangible assets

       

 

1,554

 

  

 

3,942

 

  

 

4,235

 

  

 

3,156

 

  

 

252

 

         


  


  


  


  


Total costs and expenses

       

 

43,686

 

  

 

76,841

 

  

 

96,394

 

  

 

73,468

 

  

 

98,560

 

         


  


  


  


  


Income from operations

       

 

5,228

 

  

 

18,691

 

  

 

25,923

 

  

 

18,358

 

  

 

34,996

 

         


  


  


  


  


Other income (expenses):

                                                 

Interest income

       

 

136

 

  

 

253

 

  

 

162

 

  

 

148

 

  

 

148

 

Interest expense

       

 

(4,150

)

  

 

(11,024

)

  

 

(4,518

)

  

 

(3,681

)

  

 

(2,730

)

         


  


  


  


  


         

 

(4,014

)

  

 

(10,771

)

  

 

(4,356

)

  

 

(3,533

)

  

 

(2,582

)

         


  


  


  


  


Income from continuing operations before income taxes and extraordinary item

       

 

1,214

 

  

 

7,920

 

  

 

21,567

 

  

 

14,825

 

  

 

32,414

 

Income taxes

       

 

402

 

  

 

3,262

 

  

 

8,621

 

  

 

6,148

 

  

 

13,021

 

         


  


  


  


  


Income from continuing operations before extraordinary item

       

 

812

 

  

 

4,658

 

  

 

12,946

 

  

 

8,677

 

  

 

19,393

 

Discontinued operations:

                                                 

Income from operations of discontinued operations

       

 

4,088

 

  

 

5,951

 

  

 

6,347

 

  

 

5,023

 

  

 

4,764

 

Income taxes

       

 

1,909

 

  

 

2,655

 

  

 

2,824

 

  

 

2,067

 

  

 

1,973

 

    
  


  


  


  


  


Income from discontinued operations

       

 

2,179

 

  

 

3,296

 

  

 

3,523

 

  

 

2,956

 

  

 

2,791

 

    
  


  


  


  


  


Income before extraordinary item

       

 

2,991

 

  

 

7,954

 

  

 

16,469

 

  

 

11,633

 

  

 

22,184

 

Extraordinary loss on early extinguishment of debt, net of income taxes of $3,078 in 2000

       

 

—  

 

  

 

5,393

 

  

 

—  

 

  

 

—  

 

  

 

—  

 

         


  


  


  


  


Net income

       

$

2,991

 

  

$

2,561

 

  

$

16,469

 

  

$

11,633

 

  

$

22,184

 

         


  


  


  


  


Income from continuing operations before extraordinary item per common share, basic

       

$

0.11

 

  

$

0.44

 

  

$

0.72

 

  

$

0.50

 

  

$

0.94

 

         


  


  


  


  


Income from continuing operations before extraordinary item per common share, diluted

       

$

0.11

 

  

$

0.39

 

  

$

0.66

 

  

$

0.45

 

  

$

0.88

 

         


  


  


  


  


Earnings per common share, basic

       

$

0.41

 

  

$

0.24

 

  

$

0.92

 

  

$

0.67

 

  

$

1.08

 

         


  


  


  


  


Earnings per common share, diluted

       

$

0.39

 

  

$

0.21

 

  

$

0.84

 

  

$

0.60

 

  

$

1.01

 

         


  


  


  


  


 

 

See accompanying notes.

 

 

F-4


Table of Contents

 

FTI CONSULTING, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

 

CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF STOCKHOLDERS’ EQUITY

 

    

Common

Stock


    

Additional

Paid-in

Capital


      

Unearned

Compensation


    

Retained

Earnings


    

Accumulated

Other Comprehensive

Income (Loss)


    

Total


 
    

(dollars in thousands)

 

Balance at January 1, 1999

  

$

73

 

  

$

16,506

 

    

$

 

  

$

9,015

    

$

 

  

$

25,594

 

Issuance of 828,808 warrants to purchase common stock

  

 

 

  

 

1,291

 

    

 

 

  

 

    

 

 

  

 

1,291

 

Issuance of 198,015 shares of common stock under Employee Stock Purchase Plan

  

 

2

 

  

 

374

 

    

 

 

  

 

    

 

 

  

 

376

 

Net income for 1999

  

 

 

             

 

 

  

 

2,991

    

 

 

  

 

2,991

 

    


  


    


  

    


  


Balance at December 31, 1999

  

 

75

 

  

 

18,171

 

    

 

 

  

 

12,006

    

 

 

  

 

30,252

 

Issuance of warrants to purchase 1,005,606 shares of common stock in connection with debt refinancing

  

 

 

  

 

3,714

 

    

 

 

  

 

    

 

 

  

 

3,714

 

Issuance of 1,222,500 shares of common stock for the acquisition of Policano & Manzo, L.L.C.

  

 

12

 

  

 

5,489

 

    

 

 

  

 

    

 

 

  

 

5,501

 

Issuance of 906,756 shares of common stock in exchange for debt to sellers of acquired businesses

  

 

9

 

  

 

2,674

 

    

 

 

  

 

    

 

 

  

 

2,683

 

Retirement of 492,001 warrants to purchase common stock in connection with debt refinancing

  

 

 

  

 

(1,272

)

    

 

 

  

 

    

 

 

  

 

(1,272

)

Issuance of 171,856 shares of common stock under Employee Stock Purchase Plan

  

 

2

 

  

 

485

 

    

 

 

  

 

    

 

 

  

 

487

 

Exercise of options and warrants to purchase 111,700 shares of common stock, including income tax benefit of $34

  

 

1

 

  

 

472

 

    

 

 

  

 

    

 

 

  

 

473

 

Issuance of 6,037,500 shares of common stock for cash, net of offering costs of $2,138

  

 

60

 

  

 

24,006

 

    

 

 

  

 

    

 

 

  

 

24,066

 

Issuance of 30,000 shares of restricted stock

  

 

 

  

 

159

 

    

 

 

  

 

    

 

 

  

 

159

 

Net income for 2000

  

 

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

  

 

2,561

    

 

 

  

 

2,561

 

    


  


    


  

    


  


Balance at December 31, 2000

  

 

159

 

  

 

53,898

 

    

 

 

  

 

14,567

    

 

 

  

 

68,624

 

Issuance of 174,906 shares of common stock under Employee Stock Purchase Plan

  

 

2

 

  

 

1,014

 

    

 

 

  

 

    

 

 

  

 

1,016

 

Exercise of options to purchase 2,498,672 shares of common stock, including income tax benefit of $8,116

  

 

25

 

  

 

19,919

 

    

 

 

  

 

    

 

 

  

 

19,944

 

Exercise of warrants to purchase 1,347,082 shares of common stock

  

 

13

 

  

 

3,445

 

    

 

 

  

 

    

 

 

  

 

3,458

 

Retirement of 311,515 shares of common stock in connection with warrant exercise

  

 

(3

)

  

 

(3,455

)

    

 

 

  

 

    

 

 

  

 

(3,458

)

Issuance of 32,100 shares of restricted stock

  

 

 

  

 

595

 

    

 

(595

)

  

 

    

 

 

  

 

—  

 

Amortization of unearned compensation expense

  

 

 

  

 

 

    

 

27

 

  

 

    

 

 

  

 

27

 

Comprehensive Income:

                                                       

Cumulative effect on prior years of changing to a different method of accounting for interest rate swaps

  

 

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

  

 

    

 

(348

)

  

 

(348

)

Other comprehensive loss—change in fair value of interest rate swaps

  

 

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

  

 

    

 

(596

)

  

 

(596

)

Net income for 2001

  

 

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

  

 

16,469

             

 

16,469

 

                                                   


Total comprehensive income

  

 

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

  

 

    

 

 

  

 

15,526

 

    


  


    


  

    


  


 

See accompanying notes.

 

F-5


Table of Contents

FTI CONSULTING, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

 

CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF STOCKHOLDERS’ EQUITY—(Continued)

    

Common

Stock


  

Additional

Paid-in

Capital


      

Unearned

Compensation


    

Retained

Earnings


    

Accumulated

Comprehensive

Other

Income (Loss)


   

Total


 
    

(dollars in thousands)

 

Balance at December 31, 2001

  

$

196

  

$

75,416

 

    

$

(568

)

  

$

31,036

    

$

(944

)

 

$

105,136

 

Payment of fractional shares

  

 

—  

  

 

(16

)

    

 

 

  

 

    

 

 

 

 

(16

)

Issuance of 111,661 shares of common stock under Employee Stock Purchase Plan

  

 

1

  

 

1,770

 

    

 

 

  

 

    

 

 

 

 

1,771

 

Issuance of 46,216 shares of common stock as part of purchase price of TFC

  

 

—  

  

 

1,010

 

    

 

 

  

 

    

 

 

 

 

1,010

 

Issuance of 3,000,000 shares of common stock as part of purchase price of BRS

  

 

30

  

 

101,850

 

    

 

 

  

 

    

 

 

 

 

101,880

 

Exercise of stock options to purchase 956,296 shares of common stock, including tax benefit of $9,090

  

 

10

  

 

13,967

 

    

 

 

  

 

    

 

 

 

 

13,977

 

Amortization of unearned compensation expense

  

 

  

 

 

    

 

157

 

  

 

    

 

 

 

 

157

 

Comprehensive Income:

                                                    

Other comprehensive income—change in fair value of interest rate swaps, net of income taxes of $86

  

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

  

 

    

 

106

 

 

 

106

 

Net income for the nine months ended September 30, 2002

  

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

  

 

22,184

    

 

 

 

 

22,184

 

                                                


Total comprehensive income

  

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

  

 

    

 

 

 

 

22,290

 

    

  


    


  

    


 


Balance at September 30, 2002 (unaudited)

  

$

237

  

$

193,997

 

    

$

(411

)

  

$

53,220

    

$

(838

)

 

$

246,205

 

    

  


    


  

    


 


 

 

 

 

See accompanying notes.

 

F-6


Table of Contents

 

FTI CONSULTING, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

 

CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS

 

    

Year ended December 31,


    

Nine months

ended September 30,


 
    

1999


    

2000


    

2001


    

2001


    

2002


 
           

(Unaudited)

 
    

(dollars in thousands)

 

Operating Activities

                                            

Net income

  

$

2,991

 

  

$

2,561

 

  

$

16,469

 

  

$

11,633

 

  

$

22,184

 

Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash provided by operating activities:

                                            

Extraordinary loss on early extinguishment of debt, before income taxes

  

 

—  

 

  

 

8,471

 

  

 

—  

 

  

 

—  

 

  

 

—  

 

Depreciation and other amortization

  

 

2,621

 

  

 

2,769

 

  

 

3,867

 

  

 

2,767

 

  

 

3,627

 

Amortization of goodwill and other intangible assets

  

 

2,313

 

  

 

4,723

 

  

 

5,049

 

  

 

3,762

 

  

 

252

 

Provisions for doubtful accounts

  

 

(197

)

  

 

(116

)

  

 

205

 

  

 

468

 

  

 

891

 

Income tax benefit from stock option exercises

  

 

—  

 

  

 

34

 

  

 

8,116

 

  

 

6,874

 

  

 

9,090

 

Non-cash stock compensation expense

                             

 

—  

 

  

 

157

 

Non-cash interest expense

  

 

—  

 

  

 

—  

 

  

 

—  

 

  

 

185

 

  

 

272

 

Other

  

 

26

 

  

 

(111

)

  

 

449

 

  

 

182

 

  

 

81

 

Changes in operating assets and liabilities:

                                            

Accounts receivable, billed and unbilled

  

 

(2,619

)

  

 

(8,199

)

  

 

(2,093

)

  

 

(12,024

)

  

 

(22,660

)

Deferred income taxes

  

 

(313

)

  

 

(254

)

  

 

(134

)

  

 

—  

 

  

 

—  

 

Income taxes recoverable/payable

  

 

730

 

  

 

(1,253

)

  

 

(473

)

  

 

(1,521

)

  

 

3,289

 

Prepaid expenses and other current assets

  

 

(199

)

  

 

(458

)

  

 

(437

)

  

 

(870

)

  

 

(519

)

Accounts payable and accrued expenses

  

 

316

 

  

 

700

 

  

 

463

 

  

 

1,377

 

  

 

715

 

Accrued compensation expenses

  

 

2,608

 

  

 

4,409

 

  

 

2,197

 

  

 

1,294

 

  

 

4,580

 

Billings in excess of services provided

  

 

15

 

  

 

2,567

 

  

 

1,630

 

  

 

5,158

 

  

 

6,501

 

Other current liabilities

  

 

109

 

  

 

(247

)

  

 

120

 

  

 

130

 

  

 

(56

)

    


  


  


  


  


Net cash provided by operating activities

  

 

8,401

 

  

 

15,596

 

  

 

35,428

 

  

 

19,415

 

  

 

28,404

 

Investing Activities

                                            

Purchase of property and equipment

  

 

(3,093

)

  

 

(6,640

)

  

 

(4,366

)

  

 

(2,485

)

  

 

(5,949

)

Proceeds from landlord reimbursements and sales of property and equipment

  

 

592

 

  

 

47

 

  

 

1,231

 

  

 

910

 

  

 

3  

 

Contingent payments to former owners of subsidiaries

  

 

(807

)

  

 

(907

)

  

 

(3,023

)

  

 

(516

)

  

 

(121

)

Acquisition of businesses including acquisition costs

  

 

—  

 

  

 

(49,404

)

  

 

(211

)

  

 

(2,244

)

  

 

(144,629

)

Change in other assets

  

 

(1,288

)

  

 

246

 

  

 

67

 

  

 

202

 

  

 

(669

)

    


  


  


  


  


Net cash used in investing activities

  

 

(4,596

)

  

 

(56,658

)

  

 

(6,302

)

  

 

(4,133

)

  

 

(151,365

)

Financing activities

                                            

Issuance of common stock and exercise of warrants and options

  

 

376

 

  

 

25,151

 

  

 

12,843

 

  

 

11,068

 

  

 

6,641

 

Borrowings under long-term debt arrangements

  

 

33,000

 

  

 

151,500

 

  

 

—  

 

  

 

—  

 

  

 

119,000

 

Retirement of detachable stock warrants

  

 

—  

 

  

 

(1,272

)

  

 

—  

 

  

 

—  

 

  

 

—  

 

Repayments of long-term debt arrangements

  

 

(35,500

)

  

 

(130,825

)

  

 

(32,334

)

  

 

(26,750

)

  

 

(8,250

)

Payment of financing fees

  

 

—  

 

  

 

(4,894

)

  

 

(17

)

  

 

(15

)

  

 

(3,668

)

Changes in other long-term liabilities

  

 

142

 

  

 

(409

)

  

 

3

 

  

 

—  

 

  

 

—  

 

    


  


  


  


  


Net cash provided by (used in) financing activities

  

 

(1,982

)

  

 

39,251

 

  

 

(19,505

)

  

 

(15,697

)

  

 

113,723

 

    


  


  


  


  


Net increase (decrease) in cash and cash equivalents

  

 

1,823

 

  

 

(1,811

)

  

 

9,621

 

  

 

(415

)

  

 

(9,238

)

Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of period

  

 

3,223

 

  

 

5,046

 

  

 

3,235

 

  

 

3,235

 

  

 

12,856

 

    


  


  


  


  


Cash and cash equivalents at end of period

  

$

5,046

 

  

$

3,235

 

  

$

12,856

 

  

$

2,820

 

  

$

3,618

 

    


  


  


  


  


 

See accompanying notes.

 

F-7


Table of Contents

FTI CONSULTING, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

 

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

(dollars in tables expressed in thousands, except per share data)

 

1.    Description of Business and Significant Accounting Policies

 

Basis of Presentation of Financial Statements

 

Description of Business

 

FTI Consulting, Inc. and subsidiaries (the “Company” or “FTI”) is a U.S. provider of turnaround, restructuring, bankruptcy and related consulting services. The Company’s highly skilled professionals assist distressed companies in improving their financial position or their creditors or other stakeholders in maximizing recovery of their claims. The Company also provides other consulting services such as corporate recovery, forensic accounting, fraud investigation and asset tracing, regulatory, intellectual property and mergers and acquisitions advisory services. The Company’s trial support practice group advises clients in all phases of litigation, including pre-filing, discovery, jury selection, trial preparation, expert testimony and the actual trial. At September 30, 2002 the Company had 1,050 employees (including 284 employees in the applied sciences practice group) in over 33 locations throughout the United States.

 

Principles of Consolidation

 

The consolidated financial statements include the accounts of the Company and its wholly-owned subsidiaries. All significant intercompany transactions have been eliminated.

 

Unaudited Interim Financial Information

 

The unaudited interim financial information as of September 30, 2002 and for the nine months ended September 30, 2001 and 2002 has been prepared in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles for interim financial information and with the instructions to Article 10 of Regulation S-X. In the opinion of management, such information contains all adjustments, consisting only of normal recurring adjustments considered necessary for a fair presentation of such period. The operating results for any interim period are not necessarily indicative of results for any future periods.

 

Significant Accounting Policies

 

Use of Estimates

 

The preparation of financial statements in conformity with generally accepted accounting principles requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the amounts reported in the consolidated financial statements and accompanying notes. Actual results could differ from those estimates.

 

The Company uses estimates to determine the amount of the allowance for doubtful accounts necessary to reduce accounts receivable and unbilled receivables to their expected net realizable value. The Company estimates the amount of the required allowance by reviewing the status of significant past-due receivables and analyzing historical bad debt trends. Actual collection experience has not varied significantly from estimates, due primarily to credit policies, collection experience, and a lack of concentrations of accounts receivable. Accounts receivable balances are not collateralized.

 

Estimates are also required in such areas as the Company’s self-insurance reserves for certain employee benefit plans and other ordinary accruals. Such estimates are based upon historical trends, current experience and knowledge of relevant factors.

 

Cash Equivalents

 

The Company considers all highly liquid investments with maturity of three months or less when purchased to be cash equivalents.

 

F-8


Table of Contents

FTI CONSULTING, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

 

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

 

1.    Description of Business and Significant Accounting Policies (continued)

 

Property and Equipment

 

Property and equipment is stated at cost and depreciated using the straight-line method. Furniture and equipment are depreciated over estimated useful lives ranging from three to seven years, and leasehold improvements are amortized over the lesser of the estimated useful life of the asset or the lease term.

 

Goodwill

 

Goodwill consists of the excess of the purchase price over the fair value of tangible and identifiable intangible net assets acquired in purchase business combinations. Prior to January 1, 2002, goodwill was amortized over periods ranging from 20 to 25 years. Commencing January 1, 2002, goodwill is not amortized, but is tested annually for impairment at the reporting unit level. Impairment is the condition that exists when the carrying amount of goodwill exceeds its implied fair value. The implied fair value of goodwill is the amount determined by deducting the estimated fair value of all tangible and identifiable intangible net assets of the reporting unit from the estimated fair value of the reporting unit. If the recorded value of goodwill exceeds its implied value, an impairment charge is recorded for the excess. (See also Note 1, Impact of Adoption of Recent Accounting Pronouncements.)

 

Impairment of Long-Lived Assets Excluding Goodwill

 

Long-lived assets, excluding goodwill, are reviewed for impairment whenever events or changes in circumstances indicate that the carrying amount of an asset or group of assets may not be fully recoverable. These events or changes in circumstances may include a significant deterioration of operating results, changes in business plans, or changes in anticipated future cash flows. If an impairment indicator is present, the Company evaluates recoverability by a comparison of the carrying amount of the assets to future undiscounted net cash flows expected to be generated by the assets. Assets are grouped at the lowest level for which there is identifiable cash flows that are largely independent of the cash flows generated by other asset groups. If the assets are impaired, the impairment recognized is measured by the amount by which the carrying amount exceeds the fair value of the assets. Fair value is generally determined by estimates of discounted cash flows. The discount rate used in any estimate of discounted cash flows would be the rate required for a similar investment of like risk.

 

Assets to be disposed of are reported at the lower of carrying values or fair values, less estimated costs of disposal.

 

Revenue Recognition

 

The Company derives most of its revenues from professional service activities. The vast majority of these activities are provided under “time-and-materials” billing arrangements, and revenues, consisting of billed fees and pass-through expenses, are recorded as work is performed and expenses are incurred. Revenues recognized but not yet billed to clients, have been recorded as unbilled receivables in the accompanying consolidated balance sheets. Billings in excess of services provided represents amounts billed to clients, such as retainers, in advance of work being performed.

 

F-9


Table of Contents

FTI CONSULTING, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

 

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

 

1.    Description of Business and Significant Accounting Policies (continued)

 

Direct Cost of Revenues

 

Direct cost of revenues consists primarily of billable employee compensation and related payroll benefits, the cost of consultants assigned to revenue-generating activities and direct expenses billable to clients. Direct cost of revenues does not include an allocation of overhead costs.

 

Stock Options and Stock Granted to Employees

 

The Company records compensation expense for all stock-based compensation plans using the intrinsic value method prescribed by APB Opinion No. 25, Accounting for Stock Issued to Employees (“APB No. 25”). Under APB No. 25, compensation expense is recorded over the vesting period to the extent that the fair value of the underlying stock on the date of grant exceeds the exercise or acquisition price of the stock or stock-based award. Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No. 123, Accounting for Stock-Based Compensation (“Statement 123”) encourages companies to recognize expense for stock-based awards based on their estimated value on the date of grant. Statement 123 requires the disclosure of pro forma income and earnings per share data in the notes to the financial statements if the fair value method is not adopted. The Company has supplementally disclosed in Note 7 the required pro forma information as if the fair value method had been adopted.

 

The Company also periodically issues restricted and unrestricted stock to employees in connection with new hires and performance evaluations. The fair market value on the date of issue of unrestricted stock is immediately charged to compensation expense, and the fair value on the date of issue of restricted stock is charged to compensation expense ratably over the restriction period.

 

Income Taxes

 

The Company uses the liability method of accounting for income taxes. Under this method, deferred tax assets and liabilities are determined based on differences between financial reporting and tax bases of assets and liabilities, and are measured using the enacted tax rates and laws that will be in effect when the differences are expected to reverse.

 

Accounting Change and Interest Rate Swaps

 

Effective January 1, 2001, the Company adopted Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No. 133, Accounting for Derivative Instruments and Hedging Activities, as amended, which requires that all derivative instruments be reported on the balance sheet at fair value and that changes in a derivative’s fair value be recognized currently in earnings unless specified hedge criteria are met. Under Statement 133, if an interest rate swap is designated a cash flow hedge, the effective portions of the changes in the fair value of the swap are recorded in other comprehensive income. Ineffective portions of changes in the fair value of cash flow hedges are recognized in earnings.

 

As part of managing the exposure to changes in the market interest rates on its variable rate debt, the Company has entered into various interest rate swap transactions with financial institutions acting as the counterparty. To ensure both appropriate use as a hedge and hedge accounting treatment, all swaps entered into are designated according to the hedge objective against a specific debt issue. The notional amounts, rates and maturities of the Company’s interest rate swaps are closely matched to the related terms of hedged debt obligations. None of the Company’s interest rate swaps would result in a significant loss to the Company if a counterparty failed to perform according to the terms of the agreement.

 

The Company recorded a cumulative effect adjustment to other comprehensive loss of $(348,000), net of tax, in 2001 in accordance with the transition provisions of Statement 133.

 

 

F-10


Table of Contents

FTI CONSULTING, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

 

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

 

1.    Description of Business and Significant Accounting Policies (continued)

 

Impact of Adoption of Recent Accounting Pronouncements—Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets

 

As of January 1, 2002, the Company adopted Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No. 142, Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets (“Statement 142”). Under the new rules, goodwill and other intangible assets deemed to have indefinite lives are no longer amortized, but are subject to annual impairment tests in accordance with the Statement. Other intangible assets with finite lives will continue to be amortized over their useful lives.

 

The goodwill amortization expense and net income of the Company for the three years ended December 31, 2001 and nine months ended September 30, 2002 and 2001 are as follows:

 

    

Year ended December 31


  

Nine months ended

September 30


    

1999


  

2000


  

2001


  

2001


  

2002


Reported net income

  

$

2,991

  

$

2,561

  

$

16,469

  

$

11,633

  

$

22,184

Goodwill amortization, net of income taxes

  

 

1,305

  

 

2,708

  

 

2,979

  

 

2,206

  

 

—  

    

  

  

  

  

Adjusted net income

  

$

4,296

  

$

5,269

  

$

19,448

  

$

13,839

  

$

22,184

    

  

  

  

  

Earnings per common share, basic:

                                  

Reported net income

  

$

0.41

  

$

0.24

  

$

0.92

  

$

0.67

  

$

1.08

Goodwill amortization, net of income taxes

  

 

0.18

  

 

0.26

  

 

0.17

  

 

0.13

  

 

—  

    

  

  

  

  

Adjusted net income

  

$

0.59

  

$

0.50

  

$

1.09

  

$

0.80

  

$

1.08

    

  

  

  

  

Earnings per common share, diluted:

                                  

Reported net income

  

$

0.39

  

$

0.21

  

$

0.84

  

$

0.60

  

$

1.01

Goodwill amortization, net of income taxes

  

 

0.17

  

 

0.23

  

 

0.15

  

 

0.12

  

 

—  

    

  

  

  

  

Adjusted net income

  

$

0.56

  

$

0.44

  

$

0.99

  

$

0.72

  

$

1.01

    

  

  

  

  

 

Goodwill amortization included in income from operations of discontinued operations is as follows:

 

    

Year ended December 31


  

Nine months ended

September 30


    

1999


  

2000


  

2001


  

2001


    

2002


Goodwill amortization

  

$

759

  

$

781

  

$

841

  

$

606

    

$

 

During the second quarter of 2002, the Company completed the transitional impairment tests of its recorded goodwill at January 1, 2002. No impairment of goodwill was identified as a result of these tests.

 

The changes in the carrying amount of goodwill for the nine months ended September 30, 2002, are as follows:

 

    

As

Reported


  

Less

Discontinued

Operations


    

Continuing

Operations


Balance as of January 1, 2002

  

$

90,156

  

$

(14,423

)

  

$

75,733

Goodwill acquired during the year:

                      

Contingent payments to former owners of subsidiaries

  

 

120

  

 

—  

 

  

 

120

Acquisition of TFC

  

 

3,803

  

 

—  

 

  

 

3,803

Acquisition of BRS

  

 

238,572

  

 

—  

 

  

 

238,572

    

  


  

Balance as of September 30, 2002

  

$

332,651

  

$

(14,423

)

  

$

318,228

    

  


  

 

F-11


Table of Contents

FTI CONSULTING, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

 

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

 

1.    Description of Business and Significant Accounting Policies (continued)

 

Impact of Recent Accounting Pronouncements—Accounting for the Impairment or Disposal of Long-Lived Assets

 

As of January 1, 2002, the Company adopted Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No. 144, Accounting for the Impairment or Disposal of Long-Lived Assets (“Statement 144”). Statement 144 supersedes and serves to clarify and further define the provisions of Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No. 121, Accounting for the Impairment of Long-Lived Assets and for Long-Lived Assets to Be Disposed Of, and provides a single accounting model for long-lived assets to be disposed of.

 

Statement 144 does not apply to goodwill and other intangible assets that are not amortized, and retains the Company’s current policy to recognize an impairment loss only if the carrying amount of a long-lived asset is not recoverable from its undiscounted future cash flows and to measure the impairment loss as the difference between the carrying amount and the fair value of the asset. In July 2002, the Company announced its decision to sell its applied sciences practice group, and in accordance with Statement 144, the Company has restated its December 31, 2000 and 2001 consolidated balance sheets to segregate the current and non-current assets held for sale of its discontinued operations. The consolidated statements of income for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2001 have also been restated to report the results of the Applied Sciences practice group as a separate component of net income. See Note 2 for additional information.

 

Impact of Recent Accounting Pronouncements—Reporting Extraordinary Items

 

In April 2002, the Financial Accounting Standards Board issued Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No. 145, Recission of FASB Statements No. 4, 44, and 64, Amendment of FASB Statement No. 13, and Technical Corrections (“Statement 145”). Among other changes, Statement 145 rescinds Statement 4, which required all gains and losses from extinguishment of debt to be aggregated and classified as an extraordinary item, net of the related tax effect. Statement 145 provides that gains and losses from extinguishment of debt should be classified as extraordinary items only if they are unusual or infrequent or they otherwise meet the criteria for classification as an extraordinary item, and observes that debt extinguishment transactions would seldom, if ever, result in extraordinary item classification of the resulting gains and losses. The Company will adopt Statement 145 in January 2003, and upon adoption, will report as other expenses any extraordinary losses incurred upon the extinguishment of debt. In addition, when the Company presents for comparative purposes financial statements issued prior to December 31, 2002, it will reclassify to other expenses any extraordinary losses recorded upon the early extinguishment of debt in those periods. In 2000, the Company reported a $5.4 million loss from the early extinguishment of certain debt. The Company may incur an extraordinary loss from the early extinguishment of its debt from the proceeds of this offering, as well as from application of the proceeds from its pending sale of its applied sciences practice group if the sale occurs in 2002.

 

Impact of Recent Accounting Pronouncements—Accounting for Costs Associated with Exit or Disposal Activities

 

In July 2002, the Financial Accounting Standards Board issued Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No. 146, Accounting for Costs Associated with Exit or Disposal Activities (“Statement 146”). Statement 146 supersedes EITF Issue No. 94-3 Liability Recognition for Certain Employee Termination Benefits and Other Costs to Exit an Activity. Statement 146 requires that costs associated with an exit or disposal plan be recognized when incurred rather than at the date of a commitment to an exit or disposal plan. Statement 146 is to be applied prospectively to exit or disposal activities initiated after December 31, 2002. The adoption of Statement 146 is not expected to have a significant effect on the Company’s results of operations and financial position.

 

Stock Splits

 

The Company’s board of directors authorized a 3 for 2 stock split in the form of a stock dividend to be distributed to stockholders of record on January 2, 2002. All share and per share data included in the consolidated financial statements have been restated to reflect the stock split.

 

F-12


Table of Contents

FTI CONSULTING, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

 

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

 

 

2.    Pending Sale of Applied Sciences Practice Group

 

In July 2002, the Company committed to a plan to sell its applied sciences practice group, which the Company previously reported as a separate segment. The asset disposal group comprising the applied sciences practice group is available for immediate sale in its present condition, subject only to the terms that are usual and customary for sales of such asset disposal groups. An active program to locate a buyer, and other actions required to complete the plan to sell have been initiated.

 

The sale of the asset disposal group is considered probable and is expected to be completed prior to July 2003. Actions necessary to complete the plan indicate that it is unlikely significant changes to the plan will be made or that the plan will be withdrawn.

 

The assets comprising the applied sciences asset disposal group are measured at the lower of their carrying amount or estimated fair value less cost to sell. Property and equipment held for sale with a carrying value of $1.6 million is no longer being depreciated. The Company currently expects to recover the $28.6 million carrying value of the assets of the disposal group. However, it is reasonably possible that depending on the sale price and the tax structure of the transaction, the amount realized after taxes may be less than the carrying value.

 

Assets of the applied sciences practice group held for sale are as follows:

 

    

December 31,


  

September 30,

    

2000


  

2001


  

2002


Accounts receivable, net

  

$

8,234

  

$

8,341

  

$

7,972

Unbilled receivables, net

  

 

2,841

  

 

3,224

  

 

4,117

Deferred income taxes

  

 

381

  

 

384

  

 

384

Other current assets

  

 

297

  

 

292

  

 

152

    

  

  

    

 

11,753

  

 

12,241

  

 

12,625

    

  

  

Property and equipment, net

  

 

1,423

  

 

1,634

  

 

1,553

Goodwill, net

  

 

14,718

  

 

14,423

  

 

14,423

    

  

  

Total assets of discontinued operations

  

$

27,894

  

$

28,298

  

$

28,601

    

  

  

 

Because the operations and cash flows of the applied sciences practice group will be eliminated from the ongoing operations of the Company as a result of the disposal transaction, and because the Company will not have any significant continuing involvement in the held for sale operations after the disposal transaction, the results of the applied sciences practice group’s operations are reported for all periods presented as a separate component of income, net of income taxes. Accordingly, the statements of income for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2001 have been restated to report the operations of the applied sciences practice group as a discontinued operation.

 

Summarized operating results of the applied sciences practice group are as follows:

 

    

Years Ended December 31,


  

Nine Months Ended September 30,


    

1999


  

2000


  

2001


  

2001


  

2002


Revenue

  

$

35,693

  

$

39,232

  

$

44,042

  

$

32,358

  

$

35,078

Income before income taxes

  

 

4,088

  

 

5,951

  

 

6,347

  

 

5,023

  

 

4,764

Net income

  

 

2,179

  

 

3,296

  

 

3,523

  

 

2,956

  

 

2,791

 

F-13


Table of Contents

FTI CONSULTING, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

 

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

 

 

3.    Earnings Per Share

 

The following table summarizes the computations of basic and diluted earnings per share:

 

    

Year ended December 31,


  

Nine months ended September 30,


    

1999


  

2000


    

2001


  

2001


  

2002


Numerator used in basic and diluted earnings per common share

                                    

Income from continuing operations before extraordinary item

  

$

812

  

$

4,658

 

  

$

12,946

  

$

8,677

  

$

19,393

Income from operations of discontinued operations, net of income taxes

  

 

2,179

  

 

3,296

 

  

 

3,523

  

 

2,956

  

 

2,791

Extraordinary loss on early extinguishment of debt, net of income taxes

  

 

—  

  

 

(5,393

)

  

 

—  

  

 

—  

  

 

—  

    

  


  

  

  

Net income

  

$

2,991

  

$

2,561

 

  

$

16,469

  

$

11,633

  

$

22,184

    

  


  

  

  

Denominator

                                    

Denominator for basic earnings per common share—weighted average shares outstanding

  

 

7,308

  

 

10,612

 

  

 

17,841

  

 

17,318

  

 

20,534

Effect of dilutive securities:

                                    

Warrants

  

 

173

  

 

789

 

  

 

319

  

 

426

  

 

—  

Employee stock options

  

 

62

  

 

587

 

  

 

1,471

  

 

1,485

  

 

1,477

    

  


  

  

  

    

 

235

  

 

1,376

 

  

 

1,790

  

 

1,911

  

 

1,477

    

  


  

  

  

Denominator for diluted earnings per common share— weighted average shares outstanding and conversions

  

 

7,543

  

 

11,988

 

  

 

19,631

  

 

19,229

  

 

22,011

    

  


  

  

  

Income from continuing operations before extraordinary item, basic

  

$

0.11

  

$

0.44

 

  

$

0.72

  

$

0.50

  

$

0.94

Income from operations of discontinued operations, net of income taxes, basic

  

 

0.30

  

 

0.31

 

  

 

0.20

  

 

0.17

  

 

0.14

Extraordinary loss on early extinguishment of debt, net of income taxes, basic

  

 

—  

  

 

(0.51

)

  

 

—  

  

 

—  

  

 

—  

    

  


  

  

  

Earnings per common share, basic

  

$

0.41

  

$

0.24

 

  

$

0.92

  

$

0.67

  

$

1.08

    

  


  

  

  

Income from continuing operations before extraordinary item, diluted

  

$

0.11

  

$

0.39

 

  

$

0.66

  

$

0.45

  

$

0.88

Income from operations of discontinued operations net of income taxes, diluted

  

 

0.28

  

 

0.27

 

  

 

0.18

  

 

0.15

  

 

0.13

Extraordinary loss on early extinguishment of debt, net of income taxes, diluted

  

 

—  

  

 

(0.45

)

  

 

—  

  

 

—  

  

 

—  

    

  


  

  

  

Earnings per common share, diluted

  

$

0.39

  

$

0.21

 

  

$

0.84

  

$

0.60

  

$

1.01

    

  


  

  

  

 

4.    Supplemental Disclosure of Cash Flow Information

 

In 2002, the Company acquired certain assets and liabilities of the domestic Business Recovery Services division of PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP for total consideration of $243.2 million. In connection with this acquisition, assets with a fair market value of $270.6 million and liabilities of approximately $27.4 million were assumed. See Note 5.

 

In 2000, the Company purchased the membership interests of Policano & Manzo, L.L.C. for total consideration of $54.9 million. In connection with this acquisition, assets with a fair market value of $58.1 million were acquired and liabilities of approximately $3.2 million were assumed. The Company did not make any acquisitions during 2001 or 1999.

 

F-14


Table of Contents

FTI CONSULTING, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

 

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

 

4.    Supplemental Disclosure of Cash Flow Information (continued)

 

The Company paid interest of $4.1 million, $10.8 million and $4.6 million, and income taxes of $2.0 million, $4.3 million and $6.0 million during fiscal years 1999, 2000 and 2001, respectively. The Company paid interest of $3.3 million and $2.3 million and income taxes of $2.9 million and $2.5 million for the nine months ended September 30, 2001 and 2002, respectively.

 

5.    Acquisitions

 

Domestic Business Recovery Services Division of PwC

 

On August 30, 2002, the Company acquired the domestic Business Recovery Services division of PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP (“BRS”) for $141.3 million in cash (including $1.3 million in acquisition related expenses) and 3,000,000 shares of common stock valued at $101.9 million. The fair market value of the common stock was based on the average market price of the shares over the period from two days before to two days after the date the Company entered into the definitive purchase agreement. The Company will be obligated to certain sellers that received 470,464 restricted common shares in the acquisition for additional consideration if the quoted market price of its common stock declines below $28.33 per share at the date the restrictions lapse. The amount of the additional consideration payable is the difference between $28.33 per share and the quoted market price on the date the restrictions lapse.

 

BRS was a leading provider of bankruptcy, turnaround and business restructuring services to corporations in the United States and had more than 350 people located in 15 offices across the U.S., with significant practices in New York, Dallas, Los Angeles, Chicago and Atlanta. The acquisition of BRS enhances the Company’s ability to provide consulting services in the largest and most complex turnarounds, restructurings and bankruptcies. The BRS acquisition diversifies the Company’s client base, while adding a pool of more than 350 professionals. The Company recorded significant goodwill in the acquisition as a result of the ability to earn a higher rate of return from the acquired business than would be expected if those net assets had to be acquired or developed separately.

 

The Company believes the goodwill recorded as a result of the BRS acquisition will be fully deductible for income tax purposes. The results of operations of BRS are included in the accompanying consolidated financial statements commencing August 31, 2002.

 

The following combined unaudited pro forma consolidated results of operations of the Company give effect to the acquisition of BRS as if it occurred as of the beginning of the period being reported on. The results are not necessarily indicative of what would have occurred had these transactions been consummated as of the beginning of the period, or of future operations of the Company.

 

      

Year Ended December 31, 2001


    

Nine Months Ended September 30, 2002


Revenue

    

$

289,561

    

$

242,604

Income from continuing operations before income taxes

    

 

53,857

    

 

49,854

Earnings per common share from continuing operations, diluted

    

$

1.43

    

$

1.21

 

The acquisition was accounted for using the purchase method of accounting. The following table summarizes the fair values of the assets acquired and liabilities assumed at the date of acquisition. The Company allocated the cost of the acquisition of BRS to identifiable assets and liabilities based upon their relative fair values.

 

F-15


Table of Contents

FTI CONSULTING, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

 

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

 

 

5.    Acquisitions (continued)

 

Domestic Business Recovery Services Division of PwC (continued)

 

At August 30, 2002

           

Current assets:

           

Accounts receivable, net of allowances

       

$

9,654

Unbilled receivables, net of allowances

       

 

17,238

         

         

 

26,892

         

Estimated intangible assets subject to amortization (estimated two year weighted-average useful life)

           

Contracts, backlog

  

4,200

      

Intellectual property

  

360

      

Non-compete agreement

  

540

      
    
      
         

 

5,100

Goodwill

       

 

238,572

         

Total assets acquired

       

 

270,564

         

Current liabilities:

           

Accrued compensation

       

 

1,709

Billings in excess of services provided

       

 

25,641

         

Total liabilities assumed

       

 

27,350

         

Net assets acquired

       

$

243,214

         

 

Technology & Financial Consulting, Inc.

 

On January 2, 2002, the Company completed the acquisition of all of the outstanding common stock of Technology & Financial Consulting, Inc. (“TFC”). TFC, based in Houston, Texas, provides intellectual property consulting services. As a result of the acquisition, the Company added a new practice area to its service offerings. The total purchase price was $4.1 million, including cash payments of $3.1 million and common stock valued at $1.0 million. The value of the 46,216 common shares issued was determined based on the average market price of the shares over the period from two days before to two days after the date the Company entered into the definitive purchase agreement on December 31, 2001. The acquisition was accounted for using the purchase method of accounting. In connection with the acquisition, assets with a fair market value of $4.3 million including approximately $3.8 million of goodwill were acquired and liabilities of $33,000 were assumed. The results of operations of TFC are included in the accompanying consolidated financial statements commencing January 2, 2002.

 

Policano & Manzo, L.L.C.

 

Effective January 31, 2000, the Company acquired the membership interests of Policano & Manzo, L.L.C. (“P&M”). P&M, based in Saddle Brook, New Jersey, is a leader in providing bankruptcy and turnaround consulting services to large corporations, money center banks and secured lenders throughout the U.S. The purchase price totaled approximately $54.9 million, consisting of $48.3 million in cash, 1,222,000 shares of common stock valued at $5.5 million and acquisition related expenses of $1.1 million. The acquisition was accounted for using the purchase method of accounting and approximately $52.2 million of goodwill was recorded. The results of operations of P&M are included in the accompanying consolidated statements of income commencing January 31, 2000.

 

F-16


Table of Contents

FTI CONSULTING, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

 

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

 

 

5.    Acquisitions (continued)

 

Contingent Payments to Previous Owners

 

In 2001, the Company paid contingent consideration aggregating approximately $3.0 million to the former shareholders of Klick, Kent & Allen, Inc., a company acquired in 1998, and the former shareholder of L.W.G., Inc., a company acquired in 1997. The contingent payments were attributed to the achievement of specified pre-tax earnings. Additionally, the Company paid the working capital adjustment balance of $211,000 to the former equity holders of P&M, which was acquired in 2000. There are no remaining contingent payments for any of the previous acquisitions of the Company.

 

6.    Long-Term Debt

 

Long-term debt consists of the following:

 

    

December 31,


 
    

2000


    

2001


 

Amounts due under an $80.0 million long-term credit facility, consisting of an amortizing term loan of $32.5 million and a $47.5 million revolving credit line, (of which zero was drawn at December 31, 2001), bearing interest at LIBOR plus variable percentages (4.02% at December 31, 2001). This facility is secured by substantially all the assets of the Company, and the unpaid principal matures in varying amounts through December 31, 2005.

  

$

60,500

 

  

$

28,166

 

Less current portion

  

 

(4,333

)

  

 

(4,333

)

    


  


Total long-term debt

  

$

56,167

 

  

$

23,833

 

    


  


 

On August 30, 2002, the Company terminated its previous credit facility and entered into a new credit facility in connection with the acquisition of BRS. The new credit facility consists of the pre-existing term loan of $26.0 million, a new term loan of $74.0 million and a new revolving credit facility for $100.0 million. On September 30, 2002, $1.1 million of the $26.0 million term loan was repaid. The debt under the new credit facility bears interest at an annual rate equal to LIBOR plus an applicable margin or an alternative base rate defined as the higher of (1) the lender’s announced prime rate or (2) the federal funds rate plus the sum of 50 basis points and an applicable margin. If not prepaid, the $24.9 million term loan will mature on December 1, 2005, and the $74.0 million term loan will mature on August 30, 2006. Under the credit facility, the lenders have a security interest in substantially all of the Company’s assets.

 

At September 30, 2002, outstanding debt under the new credit facility was $138.9 million including the balance of the revolving line of credit of $40.0 million, bearing interest at 4.95%. Under the terms of the new credit facility the Company must apply at least half of the net proceeds obtained from any public offering of its equity securities to the repayment of the debt. Also, under the new credit facility, the Company is required to apply all of the proceeds from the sale of its applied sciences practice group to reduce the outstanding debt.

 

F-17


Table of Contents

FTI CONSULTING, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

 

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

 

6.    Long-Term Debt (continued)

 

Aggregate maturities of debt at September 30, 2002 are as follows:

 

2002

  

$

1,083

 

2003

  

 

20,000

 

2004

  

 

26,417

 

2005

  

 

30,000

 

2006

  

 

61,416

 

    


    

 

138,916

 

Less current portion

  

 

(16,083

)

    


Total

  

$

122,833

 

    


 

The Company has entered into interest rate swap transactions on a portion of outstanding amortizing term loans. At September 30, 2002, the notional amount of the interest rate swap transaction was $24.9 million. The swap transactions resulted in exchanging floating LIBOR rates for a fixed rate of 6.64%, and expire in 2004. The changes in the fair value of the swaps are recognized in the consolidated financial statements as changes in accumulated other comprehensive income (loss). During 2001 and 2002, the Company did not recognize a net gain (loss) related to the interest rate swap transactions as there was no ineffective portion of the cash flow hedge nor was there any portion of the hedged instrument excluded from the assessment of hedge effectiveness. During the next twelve months, the Company does not expect to reclassify the effective portion of the cash flow hedge captured in other comprehensive income (loss) as it does not expect a change in the probability assessment regarding the forecasted cash flows generated from the interest rate swap transaction and the related debt obligations.

 

The Company is required to comply with certain financial and non financial covenants contained in the revolving credit and term loan agreements. The Company is in compliance with all covenants as stipulated in the agreements. The terms of the credit facility prohibit the payment of dividends without the consent of the lender.

 

The fair value of long-term debt approximates its carrying value at September 30, 2002.

 

7.    Stock Option Plans

 

Prior to 1997, the Company granted options to key employees under the 1992 Stock Option Plan. This plan was terminated in 1997 upon the adoption of the 1997 Stock Option Plan. The 1997 Plan, provides for the granting to employees and non-employee directors of qualified and non-qualified options to purchase an aggregate of up to 6,225,000 shares of common stock. Options to purchase common stock may be granted at prices not less than 50% of the fair market value of the common stock at the date of grant, for a term of no more than ten years. Vesting provisions for individual awards are at the discretion of the Board of Directors.

 

F-18


Table of Contents

FTI CONSULTING, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

 

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

 

 

7.    Stock Option Plans (continued)

 

The following table summarizes the option activity under the plans for the three-year period ended December 31, 2001:

 

   

1999


    

1999

Weighted Avg. Exercise Price


 

2000


    

2000

Weighted Avg. Exercise Price


 

2001


    

2001

Weighted Avg. Exercise Price


Options outstanding at January 1

 

2,731,244

 

  

$

5.24

 

3,027,044

 

  

$

4.74

 

4,896,193

 

  

$

  4.74

Options granted

 

596,250

 

  

 

2.83

 

2,013,300

 

  

 

4.65

 

853,331

 

  

 

17.11

Options exercised

 

—  

 

  

 

—  

 

(96,701

)

  

 

3.71

 

(2,498,672

)

  

 

4.69

Options forfeited

 

(300,450

)

  

 

5.50

 

(47,450

)

  

 

4.69

 

(79,000

)

  

 

3.65

   

  

 

  

 

  

Options outstanding at December 31

 

3,027,044

 

  

$

4.74

 

4,896,193

 

  

$

4.74

 

3,171,852

 

  

$

8.09

   

  

 

  

 

  

Options exercisable at December 31

 

1,796,387

 

  

$

5.25

 

2,655,200

 

  

$

4.99

 

1,024,352

 

  

$

5.25

   

  

 

  

 

  

 

All options granted have an exercise price equal to or greater than the fair value of the Company’s common stock on the date of grant. Exercise prices for options outstanding as of December 31, 2001, ranged from $1.92 to $21.20 as follows:

 

Range of

Exercise

Prices


  

Outstanding

Options


    

Weighted Average Exercise Price of Outstanding

Options


    

Weighted Average Remaining Contractual Life of Outstanding

Options


  

Exercisable

Options


    

Weighted Average Exercise Price of Exercisable

Options


$1.92–$4.42

  

1,738,488

    

$

4.15

    

7.89 years

  

613,488

    

$

4.15

$4.46–$9.00

  

617,693

    

$

6.40

    

7.52 years

  

352,693

    

$

6.11

$10.72–$21.20

  

815,671

    

$

17.76

    

9.49 years

  

58,171

    

$

11.72

    
                  
        
    

3,171,852

                  

1,024,352

        
    
                  
        

 

Pro Forma Disclosures Required by Statement 123

 

For the years ended December 31, 1999, 2000 and 2001, pro forma net income and earnings per share information required by Statement 123 has been determined as if the Company had accounted for its stock options using the fair value method rather than the intrinsic value method followed by the Company. The fair value of these options was estimated at the date of grant using the Black-Scholes option-pricing model with the following assumptions:

 

    

Year ended December 31,


    

1999


  

2000


  

2001


Risk free interest rate

  

5.5%

  

5.5%

  

4.5%

Expected dividend yield

  

   0%

  

   0%

  

   0%

Expected option life

  

4 years

  

4 years

  

3.38 years

Expected stock price volatility

  

0.788–0.808

  

0.779–0.790

  

0.758–0.782

Weighted average fair value of granted
Options

  

$1.77

  

$2.09

  

$9.40

 

The Black-Scholes option pricing model and other models were developed for use in estimating the fair value of traded options, which have no vesting restrictions and are fully transferable. In addition, option valuation models require the input of highly subjective assumptions, including the expected stock price volatility.

 

F-19


Table of Contents

FTI CONSULTING, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

 

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

 

 

7.    Stock Option Plans (continued)

 

Because the Company’s stock options have characteristics significantly different from those of traded options and because changes in the subjective input assumptions can materially affect the fair value estimate, in management’s opinion, the existing models do not necessarily provide a reliable single measure of the fair value of its stock options.

 

For purposes of pro forma disclosures, the estimated fair value of the options is amortized to expense over the options’ vesting period.

 

The following table summarizes pro forma income (loss) and earnings (loss) per share:

 

    

Year ended December 31,


    

1999


  

2000


    

2001


Net income, as reported

  

$

2,991

  

$

2,561

 

  

$

16,469

Pro forma net income (loss)

  

$

1,820

  

$

(197

)

  

$

14,100

Earnings per common share, basic, as reported

  

$

0.41

  

$

0.24

 

  

$

0.92

Pro forma earnings (loss) per common share, basic

  

$

0.25

  

$

(0.02

)

  

$

0.79

Earnings per common share, diluted, as reported

  

$

0.39

  

$

0.21

 

  

$

0.84

Pro forma earnings (loss) per common share, diluted

  

$

0.24

  

$

(0.02

)

  

$

0.72

 

8.    Income Taxes

 

Significant components of the Company’s deferred tax assets and liabilities are as follows:

 

    

December 31,


 
    

2000


    

2001


 

Deferred tax assets:

                 

Allowance for doubtful accounts

  

$

292

 

  

$

784

 

Accrued vacation and bonus

  

 

369

 

  

 

275

 

Other

  

 

—  

 

  

 

32

 

    


  


Total deferred tax assets

  

 

661

 

  

 

1,091

 

Deferred tax liabilities:

                 

Use of cash basis for income tax purposes by subsidiary

  

 

350

 

  

 

—  

 

Goodwill

  

 

610

 

  

 

1,407

 

Capitalized software

  

 

447

 

  

 

341

 

Other

  

 

172

 

  

 

130

 

    


  


Total deferred tax liabilities

  

 

1,579

 

  

 

1,878

 

    


  


Net deferred tax liability

  

$

(918

)

  

$

(787

)

    


  


 

F-20


Table of Contents

FTI CONSULTING, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

 

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

 

 

8.    Income Taxes (continued)

 

Income tax expense (benefit), from continuing operations before extraordinary item consisted of the following:

 

    

Year ended December 31,


 
    

1999


    

2000


    

2001


 

Current:

                          

Federal

  

$

287

 

  

$

2,469

 

  

$

6,749

 

State

  

 

428

 

  

 

1,047

 

  

 

2,007

 

    


  


  


    

 

715

 

  

 

3,516

 

  

 

8,756

 

Deferred (benefit):

                          

Federal

  

 

(190

)

  

 

(145

)

  

 

(49

)

State

  

 

(123

)

  

 

(109

)

  

 

(86

)

    


  


  


    

 

(313

)

  

 

(254

)

  

 

(135

)

    


  


  


    

$

402

 

  

$

3,262

 

  

$

8,621

 

    


  


  


 

The Company’s provision for income taxes from continuing operations before extraordinary item resulted in effective tax rates that varied from the statutory federal income tax rate as follows:

 

    

Year ended December 31,


    

1999


    

2000


    

2001


Expected federal income tax provision at 34%

  

$

413

 

  

$

2,693

 

  

$

7,333

Expenses not deductible for tax purposes

  

 

40

 

  

 

283

 

  

 

74

State income taxes, net of federal benefit

  

 

29

 

  

 

374

 

  

 

1,093

Other

  

 

(80

)

  

 

(88

)

  

 

121

    


  


  

    

$

402

 

  

$

3,262

 

  

$

8,621

    


  


  

 

The income tax provisions for interim periods in 2001 and 2002 are based on the estimated tax rates applicable for the full years. The effective income tax rate in 2002 is expected to approximate 40.5%. This rate is higher than the statutory federal income tax rate of 35% due principally to state and local taxes.

 

9.    Operating Leases

 

The Company leases office space under non-cancelable operating leases that expire in various years through 2010. The leases for certain office space contain provisions whereby the future rental payments may be adjusted for increases in maintenance and insurance above specified amounts. The Company also leases certain furniture and equipment in its operations under operating leases having initial terms of less than one year.

 

Future minimum payments under non-cancelable operating leases with initial terms of one year or more consist of the following at December 31, 2001:

 

2002

  

$  5,470

2003

  

5,333

2004

  

4,982

2005

  

4,650

2006

  

3,479

Thereafter

  

11,928

    

Total minimum lease payments

  

$35,842

    

 

F-21


Table of Contents

FTI CONSULTING, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

 

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

 

 

9.    Operating Leases (continued)

 

Rental expense consists of the following:

 

    

Year ended December 31,


    

1999


  

2000


  

2001


Furniture and equipment

  

$

359

  

$

323

  

$

375

Office and storage

  

 

2,443

  

 

2,206

  

 

3,586

    

  

  

    

$

2,802

  

$

2,529

  

$

3,961

    

  

  

 

10.    Employee Benefit Plans

 

The Company maintains a qualified defined contribution 401(k) plan, which covers substantially all employees. Under the plan, participants are entitled to make both pre-tax and after-tax contributions. The Company matches a certain percentage of participant contributions pursuant to the terms of the plan, which are limited to a percent of the participant’s eligible compensation. The percentage match is at the discretion of the Board of Directors. The Company made contributions of $344,000, $685,000 and $1.1 million during 1999, 2000 and 2001, respectively, related to these plans.

 

The Company also maintains an Employee Stock Purchase Plan, which covers substantially all employees. Under the Plan, participants are eligible to purchase shares of the Company’s common stock at a price that is equal to 85% of the lesser of the fair market value of the stock on the first or the last trading day of the offering period. Offering periods commence the first day of each January and July in any particular year. There are 750,000 shares of the Company’s common stock issuable under the Plan, of which 608,350 shares have been issued or subscribed for as of December 31, 2001.

 

11.    Extraordinary Loss

 

In connection with the acquisition of P&M, the Company refinanced its debt during the first quarter of 2000 and retired all long-term debt outstanding at February 4, 2000. In connection with this early extinguishment of debt, the Company wrote off unamortized debt discount and financing fees, incurring an extraordinary loss of $869,000 (net of a $660,000 income tax benefit).

 

During the fourth quarter of 2000, the Company successfully completed a secondary offering of 6,037,500 million shares of common stock. The $24.0 million proceeds, net of offering costs, together with internal cash resources, were used to repay the $30.0 million of subordinated notes issued in connection with the acquisition of P&M. Concurrent with the repayment of the subordinated notes, the Company refinanced its long-term debt to obtain more attractive terms and to reduce interest expense. In connection with the fourth quarter early extinguishment of debt, the Company wrote-off unamortized debt discount and financing fees and pre-payment penalties, resulting in an extraordinary loss of $4.5 million (net of a $2.4 million income tax benefit).

 

12.    Segment Reporting

 

The Company is a multi-disciplined consulting firm with leading practices in the areas of financial restructuring, litigation consulting and engineering and scientific investigation. Prior to September 1, 2002, the Company was organized into three operating segments: Financial Consulting, Litigation Consulting and Applied Sciences. As a result of the acquisition of the domestic Business Recovery Services division of PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP (“BRS”) in August 2002 and the decision to sell the Applied Sciences practice group, the Company is now managing its operations as one segment.

 

Substantially all revenue and assets are attributed to or located in the United States. The Company does not have a single customer that represents ten percent or more of consolidated revenues for any period presented.

 

F-22


Table of Contents

FTI CONSULTING, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

 

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

 

 

13.    Quarterly Financial Data (unaudited)

 

    

Quarter Ended


 
    

March 31, 2000


    

June 30, 2000


      

September 30, 2000


      

December 31, 2000


 

Revenues

  

$

21,029

 

  

$

24,902

 

    

$

23,609

 

    

$

25,992

 

Operating expenses

  

 

16,941

 

  

 

19,591

 

    

 

19,449

 

    

 

20,860

 

    


  


    


    


Operating income

  

 

4,088

 

  

 

5,311

 

    

 

4,160

 

    

 

5,132

 

Interest, net

  

 

(2,352

)

  

 

(3,142

)

    

 

(3,143

)

    

 

(2,134

)

    


  


    


    


Income from continuing operations before income taxes and extraordinary item

  

 

1,736

 

  

 

2,169

 

    

 

1,017

 

    

 

2,998

 

Income taxes

  

 

753

 

  

 

946

 

    

 

438

 

    

 

1,125

 

    


  


    


    


Income from continuing operations before extraordinary item

  

$

983

 

  

$

1,223

 

    

$

579

 

    

$

1,873

 

    


  


    


    


Income from continuing operations before extraordinary item per common share, basic

  

$

0.11

 

  

$

0.13

 

    

$

0.06

 

    

$

0.13

 

    


  


    


    


Income from continuing operations before extraordinary item per common share, diluted

  

$

0.10

 

  

$

0.11

 

    

$

0.05

 

    

$

0.12

 

    


  


    


    


Weighted average shares outstanding:

                                       

Basic

  

 

8,781

 

  

 

9,635

 

    

 

9,804

 

    

 

14,238

 

    


  


    


    


Diluted

  

 

9,600

 

  

 

11,270

 

    

 

11,604

 

    

 

15,411

 

    


  


    


    


 

    

Quarter Ended


      
 
    

March 31, 2001


    

June 30,

2001


      

September 30,

2001


      

December 31,

2001


    

March 31,

2002


    

June 30,

2002


      

September 30,

2002


 

Revenues

  

$

31,265

 

  

$

31,364

 

    

$

29,197

 

    

$

30,491

 

  

$

37,907

 

  

$

39,790

 

    

$

55,859

 

Operating expenses

  

 

24,559

 

  

 

24,584

 

    

 

24,325

 

    

 

22,926

 

  

 

28,504

 

  

 

29,280

 

    

 

40,776

 

    


  


    


    


  


  


    


Operating income

  

 

6,706

 

  

 

6,780

 

    

 

4,872

 

    

 

7,565

 

  

 

9,403

 

  

 

10,510

 

    

 

15,083

 

Interest, net

  

 

(1,443

)

  

 

(1,124

)

    

 

(966

)

    

 

(823

)

  

 

(738

)

  

 

(593

)

    

 

(1,251

)

    


  


    


    


  


  


    


Income from continuing operations income taxes

  

 

5,263

 

  

 

5,656

 

    

 

3,906

 

    

 

6,742

 

  

 

8,665

 

  

 

9,917

 

    

 

13,832

 

Income taxes

  

 

2,249

 

  

 

2,337

 

    

 

1,562

 

    

 

2,473

 

  

 

3,445

 

  

 

3,999

 

    

 

5,577

 

    


  


    


    


  


  


    


Income from continuing operations

  

$

3,014

 

  

$

3,319

 

    

$

2,344

 

    

$

4,269

 

  

$

5,220

 

  

$

5,918

 

    

$

8,255

 

    


  


    


    


  


  


    


Income from continuing operations per common share, basic

  

$

0.19

 

  

$

0.19

 

    

$

0.12

 

    

$

0.22

 

  

$

0.26

 

  

$

0.29

 

    

$

0.38

 

    


  


    


    


  


  


    


Income from continuing operations per common share, diluted

  

$

0.17

 

  

$

0.17

 

    

$

0.12

 

    

$

0.20

 

  

$

0.24

 

  

$

0.27

 

    

$

0.36

 

    


  


    


    


  


  


    


Weighted average shares outstanding:

                                                                    

Basic

  

 

15,933

 

  

 

17,228

 

    

 

18,760

 

    

 

19,397

 

  

 

19,783

 

  

 

20,176

 

    

 

21,623

 

    


  


    


    


  


  


    


Diluted

  

 

18,051

 

  

 

19,202

 

    

 

20,340

 

    

 

20,827

 

  

 

21,353

 

  

 

21,647

 

    

 

23,010

 

    


  


    


    


  


  


    


 

14.    Contingencies

 

The Company is subject to legal actions arising in the ordinary course of its business. In management’s opinion, the Company has adequate legal defenses and/or insurance coverage with respect to the eventuality of such actions and does not believe any settlement would materially affect the Company’s financial position.

 

F-23


Table of Contents

INDEPENDENT AUDITORS’ REPORT

 

To the Partners of PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP

 

We have audited the accompanying statements of assets and liabilities of PricewaterhouseCoopers Business Recovery Services Excluding its Broker/Dealer Activities (referred to as the “Business”), a business of PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP (“PwC LLP” or “PwC U.S.”), as of June 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002, and the related statements of income before partner distributions and benefits, cash flows and changes in PwC U.S. Investment for the years then ended. These financial statements are the responsibility of both PwC U.S. and the Business’ management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these financial statements based on our audits.

 

We conducted our audits in accordance with auditing standards generally accepted in the United States of America. Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. An audit also includes assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall financial statement presentation. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.

 

In our opinion, such financial statements present fairly, in all material aspects, the financial position of PricewaterhouseCoopers Business Recovery Services Excluding its Broker/Dealer Activities as of June 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002, and its income before partner distributions and benefits and its cash flows for the years then ended in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America.

 

/S/    DELOITTE & TOUCHE LLP

 

New York, New York

August 9, 2002

 

F-24


Table of Contents

PRICEWATERHOUSECOOPERS BUSINESS RECOVERY SERVICES

EXCLUDING ITS BROKER/DEALER ACTIVITIES

 

STATEMENTS OF ASSETS AND LIABILITIES

JUNE 30, 2000, 2001 AND 2002

(In Thousands)

 

    

2000


  

2001


    

2002


 

ASSETS

                        

CURRENT ASSETS:

                        

Accounts receivable (net of allowances of $7,068, $9,074 and $11,637 at June 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002, respectively)

  

$

9,407

  

$

13,076

 

  

$

15,600

 

Unbilled receivables

  

 

12,176

  

 

20,293

 

  

 

19,730

 

Prepaid and other current assets

  

 

—  

  

 

187

 

  

 

211

 

    

  


  


Total current assets

  

 

21,583

  

 

33,556

 

  

 

35,541

 

TOTAL ASSETS

  

$

21,583

  

$

33,556

 

  

$

35,541

 

    

  


  


LIABILITIES AND PwC U.S. INVESTMENT

                        

CURRENT LIABILITIES:

                        

Accrued payroll and related benefits (Note 5)

  

$

3,114

  

$

5,501

 

  

 

6,765

 

Amounts due to PwC U.S. (Note 4)

  

 

4,263

  

 

4,139

 

  

 

3,184

 

Accounts payable and accrued liabilities

  

 

653

  

 

530

 

  

 

521

 

Billings in excess of services earned

  

 

11,287

  

 

26,393

 

  

 

45,003

 

    

  


  


Total current liabilities

  

 

19,317

  

 

36,563

 

  

 

55,473

 

COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENCIES (Note 6)

                        

PwC U.S. INVESTMENT

  

 

2,266

  

 

(3,007

)

  

 

(19,932

)

    

  


  


TOTAL LIABILITIES AND PwC U.S. INVESTMENT

  

$

21,583

  

$

33,556

 

  

$

35,541

 

    

  


  


 

 

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these financial statements.

 

F-25


Table of Contents

PRICEWATERHOUSECOOPERS BUSINESS RECOVERY SERVICES

EXCLUDING ITS BROKER/DEALER ACTIVITIES

 

INCOME STATEMENTS BEFORE PARTNER DISTRIBUTIONS AND BENEFITS

YEAR ENDED JUNE 30, 2000, 2001 AND 2002

(In Thousands)

 

    

2000


  

2001


  

2002


REVENUES

  

$

141,093

  

$

156,948

  

$

179,262

Cost of services*

  

 

60,744

  

 

64,943

  

 

64,642

Reimbursables and subcontractor costs

  

 

9,401

  

 

12,844

  

 

14,275

    

  

  

Total costs of services*

  

 

70,145

  

 

77,787

  

 

78,917

Selling, general and administrative expenses*

  

 

30,851

  

 

28,387

  

 

33,542

    

  

  

Operating Income*

  

 

40,097

  

 

50,774

  

 

66,803

Interest expense

  

 

422

  

 

715

  

 

603

Other expense

  

 

364

  

 

605

  

 

584

    

  

  

INCOME BEFORE PARTNER DISTRIBUTIONS AND BENEFITS*

  

$

39,311

  

$

49,454

  

$

65,616

    

  

  


*    Excludes payment for partner distributions and benefits.

 

 

 

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these financial statements.

 

F-26


Table of Contents

PRICEWATERHOUSECOOPERS BUSINESS RECOVERY SERVICES

EXCLUDING ITS BROKER/DEALER ACTIVITIES

 

STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS

YEAR ENDED JUNE 30, 2000, 2001 AND 2002

(In Thousands)

 

    

2000


    

2001


    

2002


 

CASH FLOWS FROM OPERATING ACTIVITIES:

                          

Income before partner distributions and benefits

  

$

39,311

 

  

$

49,454

 

  

$

65,616

 

Adjustments to reconcile to net cash provided by (used in) operating activities:

                          

Allowance for bad debts

  

 

6,156

 

  

 

3,006

 

  

 

3,763

 

Changes in assets and liabilities:

                          

Accounts receivable

  

 

(8,305

)

  

 

(6,675

)

  

 

(6,287

)

Unbilled receivables

  

 

(2,830

)

  

 

(8,117

)

  

 

563

 

Prepaid and other current assets

  

 

109

 

  

 

(187

)

  

 

(24

)

Accrued payroll and related benefits

  

 

(518

)

  

 

2,387

 

  

 

1,264

 

Accounts payable and accrued liabilities

  

 

119

 

  

 

(123

)

  

 

(9

)

Billings in excess of services earned

  

 

8,082

 

  

 

15,106

 

  

 

18,610

 

    


  


  


Net cash provided by operating activities

  

 

42,124

 

  

 

54,851

 

  

 

83,496

 

    


  


  


CASH FLOWS FROM FINANCING ACTIVITIES:

                          

Amount (due to) from PwC U.S.

  

 

721

 

  

 

(124

)

  

 

(955

)

Activity in PwC U.S. investment, net

  

 

(42,845

)

  

 

(54,727

)

  

 

(82,541

)

Net cash used in financing activities

  

 

(42,124

)

  

 

(54,851

)

  

 

(83,496

)

    


  


  


NET INCREASE IN CASH AND CASH EQUIVALENTS

  

 

—  

 

  

 

—  

 

  

 

—  

 

CASH AND CASH EQUIVALENTS, BEGINNING OF YEAR

  

 

—  

 

  

 

—  

 

  

 

—  

 

    


  


  


CASH AND CASH EQUIVALENTS, END OF YEAR

  

$

—  

 

  

$

—  

 

  

$

—  

 

    


  


  


 

 

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these financial statements.

 

F-27


Table of Contents

PRICEWATERHOUSECOOPERS BUSINESS RECOVERY SERVICES

EXCLUDING ITS BROKER/DEALER ACTIVITIES

 

STATEMENTS OF CHANGES IN PwC U.S. INVESTMENT

JUNE 30, 2000, 2001 AND 2002

(In Thousands)

 

BALANCE AS OF JUNE 30, 1999

  

$

5,800

 

Income before partner distributions and benefits

  

 

39,311

 

Activity in PwC U.S. investment, net

  

 

(42,845

)

    


BALANCE AS OF JUNE 30, 2000

  

 

2,266

 

Income before partner distributions and benefits

  

 

49,454

 

Activity in PwC U.S. investment, net

  

 

(54,727

)

    


BALANCE AS OF JUNE 30, 2001

  

 

(3,007

)

Income before partner distributions and benefits

  

 

65,616

 

Activity in PwC U.S. investment, net

  

 

(82,541

)

    


BALANCE AS OF JUNE 30, 2002

  

$

(19,932

)

    


 

 

 

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these financial statements.

 

F-28


Table of Contents

PRICEWATERHOUSECOOPERS BUSINESS RECOVERY SERVICES

EXCLUDING ITS BROKER/DEALER ACTIVITIES

 

NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

JUNE 30, 2000, 2001 AND 2002

(In Thousands)

 

1.    NATURE OF OPERATIONS

 

The Business Recovery Services business unit excluding the broker/dealer activities (the “Business”) of PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP (“PwC LLP” or “PwC U.S.”) is a provider of financial and strategic services to under-performing and troubled businesses.

 

The Business focuses on solutions to help troubled businesses through bankruptcy advisory services, crisis management and consulting, as well as trustee and receiver services. The Business works with under-performing companies to help rebuild shareholder value.

 

On July 24, 2002, PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP and FTI Consulting, Inc. entered into an agreement for the purchase and sale of assets of the Business.

 

2.    BASIS OF PRESENTATION

 

The financial statements of the Business are prepared in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America (“U.S. GAAP”). All material inter-firm balances and transactions have been eliminated.

 

These financial statements have been derived from the books and records of PwC U.S. Accordingly, assumptions and allocations have been made which are estimates (Notes 3 and 4). Management believes that the assumptions and allocations underlying these financial statements are reasonable. Management does not believe, however, that it is practical to estimate what these expenses would have been had the Business operated as an independent entity, including any expenses associated with obtaining any of these services from unaffiliated entities. In addition, the Business receives referrals from other business units of PwC U.S. that may not continue.

 

PwC U.S. is a partnership where earnings are allocable to its partners and principals. Partnership distributions are not considered “executive compensation” in the customary sense of that term because partnership distributions are comprised of distributions of current earnings. Therefore, it is not practical to differentiate the ownership components of distributions to partners from the compensation components of such distributions. As a result, the financial statements do not reflect the assets and liabilities or income before partner distributions and benefits had the Business operated as a stand-alone entity. These benefits principally include retirement benefits and certain group insurance coverage.

 

The Merger of Coopers & Lybrand and Price Waterhouse Global Networks.    Effective July 1, 1998, substantially all of the various professional services firms comprising the global networks of Coopers & Lybrand and Price Waterhouse combined on a country-by-country or regional basis and established a new global network of combined firms that comprise PricewaterhouseCoopers (“PwC”). The PwC network of firms adopted a coordinated strategy, branding and standards of operations on a global basis under a common global management team.

 

The combination of partners’ book capital interests have been accounted for as a combination at predecessor basis as of the date of combination. In the combination of the partnerships, neither predecessor partner group received a partnership interest that represents a fair value residual equity interest in the combined partnerships. Partners’ rights are limited to the amount of their book capital contributed and any allocated but undistributed profits. Partners continued to maintain their same book capital account in the combined partnership and agreed to share profits in the combined firm on the same basis as prior to the combination.

 

F-29


Table of Contents

PRICEWATERHOUSECOOPERS BUSINESS RECOVERY SERVICES

EXCLUDING ITS BROKER/DEALER ACTIVITIES

 

NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

 

 

3.    SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES

 

Cash and Cash Equivalents—Cash and cash equivalents are managed centrally within PwC U.S. The Business does not maintain any cash and cash equivalent balances of its own.

 

Fair Value of Financial Instruments—All financial instruments, principally accounts receivable and unbilled receivables, are stated at historical cost, which approximates fair value due generally to their short-term nature.

 

Property and Equipment—The Business does not individually own property and equipment. These types of assets are not included in the statements of assets and liabilities. PwC U.S. allocates to the Business its applicable portion of facilities costs incurred by PwC U.S. See Note 4 for a discussion of allocated costs.

 

Provision for Taxes—No income tax provision is recorded in the historical financial statements of the Business, since PwC U.S. is a partnership and the tax effects accrue directly to its partners.

 

Revenue Recognition—Revenues include all amounts billable to clients, including professional services provided by partners and employees of the Business, as well as subcontractors working for the Business. Revenues are recognized in the period in which services are rendered at net realizable value. Reimbursements, including those related to travel and other out-of-pocket expenses, as well as subcontractor fees and expenses are also included in revenues. Revisions to engagement revenues recognized to date, resulting from changes in circumstances, are recorded in the period in which such changes become known.

 

Losses on contracts are recognized during the period in which the loss first becomes probable and reasonably estimable. Contract losses are determined to be the amount by which the estimated service costs of the contract exceed the estimated total revenues that will be generated by the contract.

 

Unbilled receivables represent revenues for services rendered and expenses incurred that have not yet been billed to clients.

 

Billings in excess of services earned represents amounts billed to clients in advance of work being performed (i.e. retainers, and holdbacks). Retainers are paid by clients before work has begun, and are held on deposit until completion of work. Such amounts are either applied to final billings or refunded to clients upon completion of work. Holdbacks are portions of client fees deferred by the Business or required to be held by courts of law to be realized upon completion of work. Holdbacks are recorded as reserves in billings in excess of services earned until amounts are actually collected, as collection is not certain.

 

Cost of Services—Cost of services includes employee compensation and related benefits for client service staff, outside consultants used on client engagements, the costs of their recruitment and continuing training, and an allocation of information technology costs attributable to these staff. Costs related to research and development activities are expensed as incurred.

 

Selling, General and Administrative Expenses—Selling, general and administrative expenses include general and administrative costs incurred by PwC U.S. and allocated to the Business, as well as costs incurred directly by the Business. Selling, general and administrative costs include compensation and benefits for non-client service and practice support personnel, infrastructure expenses including: rent, legal and professional indemnity insurance costs, new business development activities, information technology not attributable to client service staff, marketing, advertising and other firmwide costs.

 

F-30


Table of Contents

PRICEWATERHOUSECOOPERS BUSINESS RECOVERY SERVICES

EXCLUDING ITS BROKER/DEALER ACTIVITIES

 

NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

 

 

Allocated Costs and Partnership Distributions—PwC U.S. provides various services and infrastructure to the Business. The costs of these services are allocated to the Business on bases that PwC U.S. management believes to be reasonable. See Note 4 for a discussion of allocated costs. PwC U.S. is a partnership and its earnings are allocable to its partners. Partnership distributions are not considered “executive compensation” in the customary sense of that term because partnership distributions are comprised of distributions of current earnings. Therefore, it is not practical to differentiate the ownership components of distributions to partners from the compensation components of such distributions. Accordingly, distributions and benefits for services rendered by partners have not been reflected in the income statements before partner distributions and benefits.

 

Earnings Per Share—The Business has no single capital structure upon which to calculate earnings per share information. Accordingly, earnings per share information is not presented.

 

Credit Risk—The Business provides professional services to a diversified client base. The majority of client engagements are with major corporations and financial institutions. The Business also serves a range of troubled companies varying in size from large conglomerates to mid-cap companies that retain the Business’ services through bankruptcy trustees. The Business performs ongoing credit evaluations of its clients and may require advances or retainers prior to engagement. Accounts receivable are reviewed on a periodic basis and an allowance for bad debts is recorded where such amounts are determined to be uncollectible. Due to the large number of client accounts and the diversified client base, across many industries, management does not believe that a significant concentration of credit risk loss exists.

 

Use of Estimates—The preparation of financial statements in conformity with U.S. GAAP requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities, or the disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities at the date of the financial statements and reported revenues and expenses during the reporting period. Actual results could differ from those estimates.

 

4.    TRANSACTIONS WITH PwC

 

In the normal course of business, the Business uses the professional services of other PwC U.S. business units on the Business’ engagements. Related party revenues include billings for professional services provided by the Business to other PwC U.S. business units. For the years ended June 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002, revenues include approximately $14,000, $11,600 and $5,900, respectively, related to professional services provided to other PwC U.S. business units. Additionally, cost of services includes $32,600, $24,800 and $18,700, respectively, related to professional services received from other PwC U.S. business units. These related party transactions are settled within “PwC U.S. Investment.”

 

Settlement of Internal Costs and Expenses within PwC U.S.—PwC U.S. provides various services and infrastructure on a centralized basis to the Business including occupancy, technology services, finance and planning, human resources, marketing and business development, risk management and practice protection, firm-wide management, and new product development. The methods of allocating these centralized costs to the Business include relative revenues, headcount, square footage, or other basis. These service and infra-structure costs are paid or settled with PwC U.S. using cash provided by operations of the Business. Accordingly, these costs are credited directly to the PwC U.S. Investment account, on the basis that cash generated by the Business is distributed to PwC U.S. for the settlement of commonly incurred liabilities, acquisitions of common assets and distributions to PwC U.S. partners.

 

Total allocated costs approximated $22,723, $22,523 and $26,615 for the years ended June 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002, respectively, and are included in the accompanying statements of income before partner distributions

 

F-31


Table of Contents

PRICEWATERHOUSECOOPERS BUSINESS RECOVERY SERVICES

EXCLUDING ITS BROKER/DEALER ACTIVITIES

 

NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

 

and benefits, as follows: costs of services of $3,621, $2,239 and $2,111; selling, general and administrative expenses of $18,455, $19,349 and $23,889; interest expense of $422, $715 and $603; and other expense of $225, $220 and $12.

 

Cash receipts, which the Business generates, are collected by PwC U.S. Such cash is generally managed via common pools for all lines of service within PwC U.S. Cash generated by the Business that is managed by PwC U.S. has not been reflected in these financial statements.

 

Settlement of Costs and Expenses with Employees and Allocated Debt—PwC U.S. incurs and settles payroll and accounts payable on a centralized basis. Prepaid and other current assets and payroll taxes and deductions are allocated based on the ratio of the Business’ employee expenses to total PwC U.S. employee expenses. Certain accounts payable and accrued liabilities are also allocated based on the Business’ ratio of non-employee expense to total PwC U.S. non-employee expense. Short-term and long-term debt of PwC U.S. are allocated to the Business based on the ratio of the Business’ accounts receivable and unbilled receivables to total accounts receivable and unbilled receivables of PwC U.S. PwC U.S. interest expense (including interest on long term debt, short term debt and working capital financing) is allocated to the Business on a monthly basis using the ratio of the Business’ revenues to the total revenues of PwC U.S. This interest allocation therefore covers working capital and all intercompany debt.

 

These allocated amounts have been included in “Amounts due to PwC U.S.” in the accompanying statements of assets and liabilities and are comprised of:

 

    

June 30,


 
    

2000


    

2001


    

2002


 

Prepaid and other current assets

  

$

(150

)

  

$

(60

)

  

$

(453

)

Payroll taxes and deductions

  

 

547

 

  

 

932

 

  

 

1,473

 

Accounts payable

  

 

615

 

  

 

331

 

  

 

1,835

 

Accrued and other liabilities

  

 

726

 

  

 

941

 

  

 

329

 

Debt

  

 

2,525

 

  

 

1,995

 

  

 

0

 

    


  


  


Amounts due to PwC U.S.

  

$

4,263

 

  

$

4,139

 

  

$

3,184

 

    


  


  


 

5.    ACCRUED PAYROLL AND RELATED BENEFITS

 

Accrued payroll and related benefits consisted of the following:

 

    

June 30,


    

2000


  

2001


  

2002


Accrued bonus

  

$

2,037

  

$

4,169

  

$

5,048

Accrued vacation

  

 

1,077

  

 

1,332

  

 

1,717

    

  

  

Total accrued payroll and related benefits

  

$

3,114

  

$

5,501

  

$

6,765

    

  

  

 

The Business has various performance-driven bonus plans under which employees are awarded cash bonuses generally based upon the performance of their unit, as well as their own individual performance against predefined goals. Bonuses are generally earned and recognized within a given fiscal year and paid in the following fiscal year. Distributions and related benefits for partners have not been reflected in the income statements before partner distributions and benefits.

 

F-32


Table of Contents

PRICEWATERHOUSECOOPERS BUSINESS RECOVERY SERVICES

EXCLUDING ITS BROKER/DEALER ACTIVITIES

 

NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

 

 

6.    COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENCIES

 

Litigation—The PwC global network, as well as the Business, is involved in litigation arising in the ordinary course of business, some of which may be related to the Business’ operations. Some of the actions and proceedings have been brought on behalf of various claimants and certain of these claimants seek damages of unspecified amounts. The member firms within the PwC global network have established a series of captive insurance companies to self-insure themselves against troublesome practice matters. The insurance provided by these captive insurance companies covers, on a PwC U.S. basis, liability relating to professional services performed by the Business as well as professional services performed by all other business units within PwC U.S. Management believes that any potential losses will not exceed the designated amounts covered by the captive insurance companies. While the ultimate outcome of any outstanding litigation cannot be predicted with certainty, it is the opinion of management that the resolution of such litigation will not have a material adverse effect on the statements of assets and liabilities, income before partner distributions and benefits or cash flow of the business.

 

In December 2000, the Trustee of Keller Financial Services of Florida, Inc. filed an action in the United States of District Court for the Middle District of Florida, alleging that PwC U.S. work as the financial advisor of this former client, which subsequently went into bankruptcy, was negligent and that PwC U.S. breached its fiduciary duty by not placing the client into bankruptcy soon after PwC U.S.’s engagement began in June 1997. PwC U.S. believes it has meritorious legal defenses regarding this matter, and further, other parties may have liability to the plaintiff, which would also reduce the liability, if any, of PwC U.S. Nevertheless, it is reasonably possible that this case could result in an outcome unfavorable to PwC U.S. Because this case is still in its preliminary stages, PwC U.S. is unable to estimate the loss, or range of loss, if any, that might ultimately be incurred. PwC U.S. will retain this liability in connection with the sale to FTI.

 

In one matter, General Cinemas, the creditors have filed an objection to the firm’s final fee application in total. If successful, the firm could not collect any of the outstanding fees and would have to disgorge any fees PwC U.S. has collected to date. The total fees collected and billed but not collected are approximately $2.1 million. The matter is still in discovery. PwC U.S. is unable to estimate the loss, or range of loss, if any, that might ultimately be incurred.

 

In another matter, Aureal, the Court objected to PwC U.S.’s final fee application and ordered disgorgement of the entire fees of approximately $350,000, on various grounds. PwC U.S. is moving for reconsideration of that ruling.

 

In RSR, PwC U.S. provided advisory services to this distressed company. PwC U.S. declined thereafter to provide RSR with an affidavit for use against another PwC U.S. client in litigation and further revised to provide a tolling agreement to RSR. PwC U.S. does not believe that the former client has a viable claim should it ever be brought.

 

Leases—PwC U.S. has obligations under long-term, noncancelable, operating lease agreements, principally for office space and data processing equipment, including personal computers, some of which relate to the Business’ operations. Certain agreements are subject to periodic escalation charges for increases in real estate taxes and other charges. Renewal options are available on the majority of the office leases. No leases are held by PwC U.S. exclusively for the benefit of the Business. PwC U.S. allocates shared occupancy costs to its business units and sub-business units based on headcount and space-utilized factors.

 

Rent expense, including allocated amounts, approximated $4,352, $3,966 and $6,029 for the years ended June 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002, respectively.

 

F-33


Table of Contents

PRICEWATERHOUSECOOPERS BUSINESS RECOVERY SERVICES

EXCLUDING ITS BROKER/DEALER ACTIVITIES

 

NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

 

 

7.    EMPLOYEE BENEFIT PLANS

 

Defined Benefit Retirement and Post-retirement Benefit Plans—Historically, all employees of PwC U.S., including those of the Business, have participated in various benefit and retirement plans sponsored by PwC U.S. The costs with respect to these plans are allocated among all of the lines of service within PwC U.S. The cost allocated to the Business for defined benefit plans included within cost of services was $691, $859 and $1,032 for the years ended June 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002, respectively.

 

Additionally, PwC U.S. has unfunded post-retirement benefit plans that provide medical and life insurance for eligible retirees, employees, and dependents, as well as post-employment benefits that include severance benefits upon involuntary separation from PwC U.S. PwC U.S. has retained these plans, and therefore, for purposes of these financial statements, the assets and liabilities of these plans are not allocated to the Business. For the years ended June 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002, the Business recognized expense related to post-retirement benefit plans of $284, $308 and $481, respectively.

 

Defined Contribution Plans—PwC U.S. sponsors the Savings Plan for Employees and Partners of PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP and the Savings Plan for Employees of PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP (collectively, the “Savings Plans”), defined contribution savings plans, available to all PwC U.S. employees and partners who meet certain eligibility requirements. The Savings Plans are 401(k) based plans that allow employees to contribute up to the maximum limit established by law ($10.0, $10.5, $10.5 and $11.0 for calendar years 1999, 2000, 2001 and 2002, respectively). PwC U.S. provides a matching contribution for employees under the terms of the Savings Plans.

 

The costs allocated to the Business for defined contribution plans included in cost of services was $154, $253 and $381, for the years ended June 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002, respectively.

 

 

F-34


Table of Contents

 

[MAP]    

 

2,121,969 Shares

 

 

 

 

LOGO

 

FTI Consulting, Inc.

 

Common Stock

 

 


 

PROSPECTUS

 

                , 2003

 


 

 

LEHMAN BROTHERS

 

BANC OF AMERICA SECURITIES LLC

 

ADAMS, HARKNESS & HILL, INC.

 

JANNEY MONTGOMERY SCOTT LLC

 

SUNTRUST ROBINSON HUMPHREY


Table of Contents

PART II

 

INFORMATION NOT REQUIRED IN PROSPECTUS

 

14.    Other Expenses of Issuance and Distribution

 

The following table sets forth the various expenses payable by the Registrant in connection with the sale and distribution of the securities offered hereby. All of the amounts shown are estimated except the SEC registration fee, the National Association of Securities Dealers filing fee and the New York Stock Exchange listing fee.

 

Securities and Exchange Commission registration fee

  

$

8,241

New York Stock Exchange listing fee

  

 

7,350

National Association of Securities Dealers filing fee

  

 

9,446

Printing expenses

  

 

100,000

Legal fees and expenses

  

 

250,000

Accounting fees and expenses

  

 

500,000

Miscellaneous expenses

  

 

124,963

    

Total

  

$

1,000,000

    

 

15.    Indemnification of Officers and Directors

 

Section 2-418 of the Maryland General Corporation Law permits indemnification of directors, officers, agents and controlling persons of a corporation under certain conditions and subject to certain limitations. Registrant’s Charter and Bylaws include provisions requiring that the Registrant indemnify its directors and officers to the fullest extent permitted by Maryland General Corporation Law, including circumstances in which indemnification is otherwise discretionary.

 

The Underwriting Agreement between the Registrant and the underwriters provides for the indemnification of officers and directors of the Registrant by the underwriters against some types of liabilities arising under the Securities Act.

 

Insofar as indemnification for liabilities arising under the Securities Act of 1933 may be permitted to directors, officers or persons controlling the registrant pursuant to the foregoing provisions, the registrant has been informed that in the opinion of the Securities and Exchange Commission such indemnification is against public policy as expressed in the Act and is therefore unenforceable.

 

II-1


Table of Contents

 

16.    Exhibits

 

1.1

  

Form of Underwriting Agreement*

2.1

  

Agreement for the Purchase and Sale of Assets dated as of July 24, 2002, by and between PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP and Registrant (previously filed as Exhibit 2.1 to Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed with the SEC on July 26, 2002, and incorporated herein by reference)

4.1

  

Charter of Registrant (previously filed as Exhibit 4.1 to Registrant’s Registration Statement on Form S-8 filed with the SEC on June 28, 2001 (File No. 333-64050) and incorporated herein by reference)

4.2

  

By-Laws of Registrant, as amended and restated (previously filed as Exhibit 3.2 to Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 10-K/A for the year ended December 31, 2000, and incorporated herein by reference)

4.3

  

Registration Rights Agreement dated as of August 30, 2002, by and between Registrant, PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP and the other signatories thereto (previously filed as Exhibit 4.1 to Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed with the SEC on September 13, 2002, and incorporated herein by reference)

5.1

  

Opinion of Piper Rudnick LLP*

23.1

  

Consent of Ernst & Young LLP, Independent Auditors*

23.2

  

Consent of Deloitte & Touche LLP, Independent Auditors*

23.3

  

Consent of Piper Rudnick LLP (included in Exhibit 5.1)*

24.1

  

Power of Attorney (included on signature page)**


* Filed herewith.
** Previously filed.

 

17.    Undertakings

 

(a)    The undersigned registrant hereby undertakes that, for purposes of determining any liability under the Securities Act, each filing of the registrant’s annual report pursuant to Section 13(a) or Section 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act (and, where applicable, each filing of an employee benefit plan’s annual report pursuant to Section 15(d) of the Exchange Act) that is incorporated by reference in the registration statement shall be deemed to be a new registration statement relating to the securities offered herein, and the offering of such securities at that time shall be deemed to be the initial bona fide offering thereof.

 

(b)    Insofar as indemnification for liabilities arising under the Securities Act of 1933 may be permitted to directors, officers and controlling persons of the registrant pursuant to the foregoing provisions, or otherwise, the registrant has been advised that in the opinion of the Commission such indemnification is against public policy as expressed in the Securities Act and is, therefore, unenforceable. If a claim for indemnification against such liabilities (other than the payment by the registrant of expenses incurred or paid by a director, officer or controlling person of the registrant in the successful defense of any action, suit or proceeding) is asserted by such director, officer or controlling person in connection with the securities being registered, the registrant will, unless in the opinion of its counsel the matter has been settled by controlling precedent, submit to a court of appropriate jurisdiction the question of whether such indemnification by it is against public policy as expressed in the Securities Act and will be governed by the final adjudication of such issue.

 

The undersigned registrant hereby undertakes that:

 

(1)    For purposes of determining any liability under the Securities Act of 1933, the information omitted from the form of prospectus filed as part of this registration statement in reliance upon Rule 430A and contained in a form of prospectus filed by the registrant pursuant to Rule 424(b)(1) or (4) or 497(h) under the Securities Act shall be deemed to be part of this registration statement as of the time it was declared effective; and

 

(2)    For the purpose of determining any liability under the Securities Act of 1933, each post-effective amendment that contains a form of prospectus shall be deemed to be a new registration statement relating to the securities offered therein, and the offering of such securities at that time shall be deemed to be the initial bona fide offering thereof.

 

II-2


Table of Contents

SIGNATURES

 

Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act, the registrant certifies that it has reasonable grounds to believe that it meets all of the requirements for filing on Form S-3 and has duly caused this Amendment No. 3 to the Registration Statement to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, in the City of Annapolis, Maryland, on February 5, 2003.

 

FTI CONSULTING, INC.

By:

 

/s/    JACK B. DUNN, IV        


Jack B. Dunn, IV

Chairman of the Board and

Chief Executive Officer

 

Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, this Amendment No. 3 to the Registration Statement has been signed below by the following persons in the capacities and on the dates indicated.

 

Signature


  

Title


  

Date


/s/    JACK B. DUNN, IV    


Jack B. Dunn, IV

  

Chairman of the Board and Chief Executive Officer (principal executive officer)

  

February 5, 2003

*


Stewart J. Kahn

  

President, Chief Operating Officer and Director

  

February 5, 2003

/s/    THEODORE I. PINCUS      


Theodore I. Pincus

  

Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer (principal financial accounting officer)

  

February 5, 2003

*


Denis J. Callaghan

  

Director

  

February 5, 2003

*


James A. Flick, Jr.

  

Director

  

February 5, 2003

*


Peter F. O’Malley

  

Director

  

February 5, 2003

*


Dennis J. Shaughnessy

  

Director

  

February 5, 2003

*


George P. Stamas

  

Director


  

February 5, 2003

*By

 

/s/    THEODORE I. PINCUS        


   

Theodore I. Pincus, Attorney-in-fact

 

II-3


Table of Contents

 

 

Exhibit Index

 

1.1

  

Form of Underwriting Agreement*

2.1

  

Agreement for the Purchase and Sale of Assets dated as of July 24, 2002, by and between PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP and Registrant (previously filed as Exhibit 2.1 to Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed with the SEC on July 26, 2002, and incorporated herein by reference)

4.1

  

Charter of Registrant (previously filed as Exhibit 4.1 to Registrant’s Registration Statement on Form S-8 filed with the SEC on June 28, 2001 (File No. 333-64050) and incorporated herein by reference)

4.2

  

By-Laws of Registrant, as amended and restated (previously filed as Exhibit 3.2 to Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 10-K/A for the year ended December 31, 2000, and incorporated herein by reference)

4.3

  

Registration Rights Agreement dated as of August 30, 2002, by and between Registrant, PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP and the other signatories thereto (previously filed as Exhibit 4.1 to Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed with the SEC on September 13, 2002, and incorporated herein by reference)

5.1

  

Opinion of Piper Rudnick LLP*

23.1

  

Consent of Ernst & Young LLP, Independent Auditors*

23.2

  

Consent of Deloitte & Touche LLP, Independent Auditors*

23.3

  

Consent of Piper Rudnick LLP (included in Exhibit 5.1)*

24.1

  

Power of Attorney (included on signature page)**

 


* Filed herewith.
** Previously filed.

 

II-4


Table of Contents

FINANCIAL STATEMENT SCHEDULES

 

REPORT OF INDEPENDENT AUDITORS

ON FINANCIAL STATEMENT SCHEDULE

 

The Board of Directors and Stockholders

FTI Consulting, Inc.

 

We have audited the consolidated financial statements of FTI Consulting, Inc. as of December 31, 2000 and 2001, and for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2001, and have issued our report thereon dated November 12, 2002 (included elsewhere in this Registration Statement). Our audit also included the financial statement schedule listed as Schedule II to this Registration Statement. This schedule is the responsibility of the Company’s management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion based on our audits.

In our opinion, the financial statement schedule referred to above, when considered in relation to the basic financial statements taken as a whole, presents fairly in all material respects the information set forth therein.

 

/s/ Ernst & Young LLP

 

Baltimore, Maryland

November 12, 2002

 

 

II-5


Table of Contents

Schedule II—Valuation and Qualifying Accounts

 

All schedules, other than those outlined below, are omitted as the information is not required or is otherwise furnished.

 

FTI Consulting, Inc. and Subsidiaries

(in thousands)

 

COLUMN A


  

COLUMN B


  

COLUMN C


    

COLUMN D


    

COLUMN E


Description


  

Balance at Beginning of Period (3)


  

Additions


    

Deductions


    

Balance at End of Period (3)


     

Charged to Costs and Expenses


  

Charged to Other Accounts


       

YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2001:

                                      

Reserves and allowances deducted from asset accounts:

                                      

Allowance for doubtful accounts

  

$

1,608

  

$

2,277

  

$

—  

 

  

$

2,115

(1)

  

$

1,770

    

         


  


  

YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2000:

                                      

Reserves and allowances deducted from asset accounts:

                                      

Allowance for doubtful accounts

  

$

1,991

  

$

1,255

  

$

9

(2)

  

$

1,647

(1)

  

$

1,608

    

  

  


  


  

YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1999:

                                      

Reserves and allowances deducted from asset accounts:

                                      

Allowance for doubtful accounts

  

$

2,277

  

$

394

  

$

680

(2)

  

$

—  

 

  

$

1,991

    

  

  


  


  


(1) Uncollectible accounts written off, net of recoveries.
(2) Allowance recorded for acquisitions.
(3) Amounts exclude allowances for doubtful accounts associated with receivables held for sale. These amounts were $553 at December 31, 2001, $510 at December 31, 2000, and $234 at December 31, 1999.

 

II-6

Exhibit 1.1 2,121,969 Shares FTI Consulting, Inc. Common Stock UNDERWRITING AGREEMENT ______, 2003 Lehman Brothers Inc. Banc of America Securities LLC Adams, Harkness & Hill, INC. Janney Montgomery Scott LLC SunTrust Capital Markets, Inc. c/o Lehman Brothers Inc. 745 Seventh Avenue New York, New York 10019 Ladies and Gentlemen: FTI Consulting, Inc., a Maryland corporation (the "Company"), and certain stockholders of the Company named in Schedule II hereto and identified therein as selling stockholders (the "Selling Stockholders"), propose to sell an aggregate of 2,121,969 shares (the "Firm Securities") of the Company's common stock, par value $0.01 per share (the "Common Stock"). Of the Firm Securities, 2,100,000 are being sold by the Company and 21,969 by the Selling Stockholders. The Company also proposes to grant to the Underwriters named in Schedule I hereto (the "Underwriters") an option to purchase up to an additional 318,295 shares of the Common Stock on the terms and for the purposes set forth in Section 3 (the "Option Securities"). The Firm Securities and the Option Securities, if purchased, are hereinafter collectively called the "Securities". This is to confirm the agreement concerning the purchase of the Securities from the Company and the Selling Stockholders by the Underwriters, as of the date first written above. 1. Representations, Warranties and Agreements of the Company. The Company represents and warrants to and agrees with the Underwriters that: (a) A registration statement on Form S-3 setting forth information with respect to the Company, the Selling Stockholders and the Securities has (i) been prepared by the Company in conformity with the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, and the rules and regulations of the Securities and Exchange Commission (the "Commission") thereunder (collectively, the "Securities Act"), (ii) been filed with the Commission under the Securities Act and (iii) become effective under the Securities Act. Copies of such registration statement (and any amendments thereto) and all exhibits thereto have been delivered by the Company to you as the representatives of the Underwriters (the "Representatives"). As used in this Agreement, "Effective Time" means the date and the time as of which such registration statement, or the most recent post-effective amendment thereto, if any, was declared effective by the

2 Commission; "Effective Date" means the date of the Effective Time; "Preliminary Prospectus" means each preliminary prospectus contained in such registration statement, or amendments thereof, before it became effective under the Securities Act and any prospectus filed with the Commission by the Company with the consent of the Representatives pursuant to Rule 424(a) of the Securities Act; "Registration Statement" means such registration statement, as amended as of the Effective Time, including any documents incorporated by reference therein at such time and all information contained in the final prospectus filed with the Commission pursuant to Rule 424(b) of the Securities Act and deemed to be a part of the registration statement as of the Effective Time pursuant to Rule 430A of the Securities Act; and "Prospectus" means the prospectus in the form first used to confirm sales of the Securities. If the Company has filed an abbreviated registration statement to register additional Securities pursuant to Rule 462(b) under the Securities Act (the "Rule 462 Registration Statement"), then any reference herein to the term "Registration Statement" shall be deemed to include such Rule 462 Registration Statement. Reference made herein to any Preliminary Prospectus or to the Prospectus shall be deemed to refer to and include any documents incorporated by reference therein pursuant to Item 12 of Form S-3 under the Securities Act, as of the date of such Preliminary Prospectus or the Prospectus, as the case may be, and any reference to any amendment or supplement to any Preliminary Prospectus or the Prospectus shall be deemed to refer to and include any document filed under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, and the rules and regulations of the Commission thereunder (collectively, the "Exchange Act") after the date of such Preliminary Prospectus or the Prospectus, as the case may be, and incorporated by reference in such Preliminary Prospectus or the Prospectus, as the case may be; and any reference to any amendment to the Registration Statement shall be deemed to include any annual report of the Company filed with the Commission pursuant to Section 13(a) or 15(d) of the Exchange Act after the Effective Time that is incorporated by reference in the Registration Statement. The Commission has not issued any order preventing or suspending the use of the Registration Statement, the Preliminary Prospectus or the Prospectus. (b) The conditions for use of Form S-3, as set forth in the General Instructions thereto, have been satisfied. (c) The Registration Statement, as of the Effective Date, conformed in all material respects with the requirements of the Securities Act and did not contain any untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state a material fact required to be stated therein or necessary to make the statements therein not misleading, and the Prospectus and any amendment or supplement thereto, as of their respective dates and as of the applicable Delivery Date (as defined in Section 5 below), conformed and will conform in all material respects with the requirements of the Securities Act and did not and do not contain any untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state a material fact required to be stated therein or necessary to make the statements therein, in light of the circumstances under which they were made, not misleading; provided that, the Company makes no representation or warranty as to information contained in or omitted from the Registration Statement or the Prospectus in reliance upon and in conformity with written

3 information furnished to the Company by the Underwriters specifically for inclusion therein (which information is set forth in Section 10(f)). (d) The documents incorporated by reference in the Prospectus (the "Incorporated Documents"), when they became effective or were filed with the Commission, as the case may be, conformed in all material respects to the requirements of the Securities Act and the Exchange Act, as applicable, and none of such documents contained any untrue statement of a material fact or omitted to state any material fact required to be stated therein or necessary to make the statements therein not misleading; and any further documents so filed and incorporated by reference in the Prospectus, when such documents become effective or are filed with the Commission, as the case may be, will conform in all material respects to the requirements of the Securities Act or the Exchange Act, as applicable, and will not contain any untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state any material fact required to be stated therein or necessary to make the statements therein, in light of the circumstances in which they were made, not misleading. (e) The Company and each of its subsidiaries has been duly formed and is validly existing as a corporation or limited liability company in good standing under the laws of its jurisdiction of formation, is duly qualified to do business and is in good standing as a foreign corporation or limited liability company in each jurisdiction in which its ownership or lease of property or the conduct of its businesses requires such qualification, other than such jurisdictions where the failure to be so qualified or otherwise authorized to transact business would not have a material adverse effect on the business, prospects, financial condition, stockholders' equity or results of operations of the Company and its subsidiaries taken as a whole (a "Material Adverse Effect"), and has all power and authority necessary to own, lease or hold its properties and to conduct the businesses in which it is engaged. (f) The Company has an authorized and issued capitalization as set forth in the Prospectus, and all of the issued shares of capital stock of the Company have been duly and validly authorized and issued, are fully paid and non-assessable and conform to the description thereof contained in the Prospectus; and all of the issued shares of capital stock of each subsidiary of the Company have been duly and validly authorized and issued and are fully paid and non-assessable and are owned directly or indirectly by the Company, free and clear of all liens, encumbrances, equities, claims or adverse interests (collectively, "Liens") of any nature except the Liens under the Credit Facility dated as of August 30, 2002, among the Company, the lenders and other parties named therein, as amended on September 20, 2002 (the "Credit Facility"). There has been no change in the authorized or issued capitalization of the Company or any of its subsidiaries since the date indicated in the Prospectus except with respect to (i) changes occurring in the ordinary course of business, (ii) changes in outstanding Common Stock resulting from transactions relating to employee benefit plans or dividend reinvestment and employee stock purchase plans and (iii) changes described in the Prospectus. (g) Except as set forth in the Prospectus, the Company has not sold or issued any shares of Common Stock during the six-month period preceding the date of

4 the Prospectus, including any sales pursuant to Rule 144A under, or Regulations D or S of, the Securities Act other than shares issued pursuant to employee benefit plans, qualified stock options plans or other employee compensation plans or pursuant to outstanding options, rights or warrants. (h) No relationship, direct or indirect, exists between or among the Company on the one hand, and the directors, officers, stockholders, customers or suppliers of the Company on the other hand, which is required to be set forth in the Prospectus under the rules and regulations of the Commission which is not so set forth. (i) Except as set forth in the Prospectus, there are no legal or governmental proceedings pending to which the Company or any of its subsidiaries is a party or of which any property or assets of the Company or any of its subsidiaries is subject which, if determined adversely to the Company or any of its subsidiaries, could reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect; and, to the best of the Company's knowledge, no such proceedings are threatened or contemplated by governmental authorities or threatened by others. (j) There are no contracts, agreements or understandings between the Company and any person granting such person the right to require the Company to file a registration statement under the Securities Act with respect to any securities of the Company owned or to be owned, directly or indirectly, by such person, or to include any such securities in any registration statement filed by the Company, except as have been exercised or waived in connection with the offering of securities contemplated by this Agreement. (k) There are no contracts, agreements or other documents which are required to be set forth in the Prospectus or filed as exhibits to the Registration Statement by the Securities Act which have not been set forth in the Prospectus or filed as exhibits to the Registration Statement. (l) Neither the Company nor any of its subsidiaries (i) is in violation of its charter or by-laws, (ii) is in default, and no event has occurred which, with notice or lapse of time or both, would constitute such a default, in the due performance or observance of any term, covenant or condition contained in any indenture, mortgage, deed of trust, loan agreement or other agreement or instrument to which it is a party or by which it is bound or to which any of its properties or assets is subject or (iii) is in violation of any law, ordinance, governmental rule, regulation or court decree to which it or its property or assets may be subject or has failed to obtain any material license, permit, certificate, franchise or other governmental authorization or permit necessary to the ownership of its property or to the conduct of its business, except, in the case of (ii) and (iii), such defaults, events, violations or failures which, individually or in the aggregate, would not reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect. (m) Neither the Company nor any of its subsidiaries has sustained, since the date of the latest audited financial statements included in the Prospectus, any material loss or interference with its business from fire, explosion, flood or other

5 calamity, whether or not covered by insurance, or from any labor dispute or court or governmental action, order or decree (a "Material Loss"); and, since such date, there has not been any change in the capital stock, short-term debt or long-term debt of the Company or any of its subsidiaries (except as disclosed in the Prospectus) or any material adverse change, or any development involving a prospective material adverse change, in or affecting the general affairs, management, consolidated financial position, stockholders' equity, results of operations, business or prospects of the Company and its subsidiaries, taken as a whole (a "Material Adverse Change"). (n) The financial statements (including the related notes and supporting schedules) filed as part of the Registration Statement or included or incorporated by reference in the Prospectus present fairly the financial condition, the results of operations and the changes in financial position of the entities purported to be shown thereby on the basis stated therein at the respective dates or for the respective periods indicated; such statements and related schedules and notes have been prepared in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles consistently applied throughout the periods involved; the supporting schedules, if any, included or incorporated by reference in the Prospectus present fairly in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles the information required to be stated therein; and the other financial and statistical information and data set forth in the Prospectus (and any amendment or supplement thereto) are, in all material respects, accurately presented and have been prepared on a basis consistent with such financial statements and the books and records of such entities. (o) The pro forma financial statements of the Company and its subsidiaries and the related notes thereto set forth in the Prospectus (and any supplement or amendment thereto), if any, have been prepared on a basis consistent with the historical financial statements of the Company and its subsidiaries, give effect to the assumptions used in the preparation thereof on a reasonable basis and in good faith and present fairly the historical and proposed transactions contemplated by the Prospectus. Such pro forma financial statements have been prepared in accordance with the applicable requirements of Rule 11-02 of Regulation S-X promulgated by the Commission. The other pro forma financial and statistical information and data set forth in the Prospectus (and any supplement or amendment thereto) are, in all material respects, accurately presented and prepared on a basis consistent with the pro forma financial statements. (p) Ernst & Young LLP, who have certified the financial statements of the Company, whose report appears in the Prospectus and who have delivered one of the initial letters referred to in Section 9(g) hereof, are independent public accountants as required by the Securities Act; Deloitte & Touche LLP, who have certified certain financial statements relating to the Business Recovery Services business (the "BRS Business") acquired by the Company from PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP, a Delaware limited liability partnership, pursuant to an Agreement for the Purchase and Sale of Assets dated as of July 24, 2002, whose report appears in the Prospectus and who have delivered one of the initial letters referred to in Section 9(g) hereof, are independent

6 public accountants as required by the Securities Act; and both Ernst & Young and Deloitte & Touche were independent accountants as required by the Securities Act during the periods covered by the financial statements on which they reported. (q) The Company and its subsidiaries own no real property. The Company and each of its subsidiaries have good and marketable title to all personal property owned by them, in each case free and clear of all liens, encumbrances and defects except such as do not materially affect the value of such property and do not materially interfere with the use made and proposed to be made of such property by the Company and its subsidiaries and except for Liens arising under the Credit Facility; and all material assets held under lease by the Company and its subsidiaries are held by them under valid, subsisting and enforceable leases, with such exceptions as are not material and do not interfere with the use made and proposed to be made of such property and buildings by the Company and its subsidiaries. (r) The Company and each of its subsidiaries carry, or are covered by, insurance in such amounts and covering such risks as is adequate for the conduct of their respective businesses and the value of their respective properties from insurers of recognized financial responsibility and as is customary for companies engaged in similar businesses in similar industries. Neither the Company nor any of its subsidiaries (i) has received notice from any insurer or agent of such insurer that substantial capital improvements or other material expenditures will have to be made in order to continue such insurance or (ii) has any reason to believe that it will not be able to renew its existing insurance coverage as and when such coverage expires or to obtain similar coverage from similar insurers at a cost that would not have a Material Adverse Effect. (s) The Company and each of its subsidiaries has such permits, licenses, consents, exemptions, franchises, authorizations and other approvals (each, an "Authorization") of, and has made all filings with and notices to, all governmental or regulatory authorities and self-regulatory organizations and all courts and other tribunals, including, without limitation, under any applicable environmental law, ordinance, rule, regulation, order, judgment, decree or permit, as are necessary to own, lease, license and operate its respective properties and to conduct its business, except where the failure to have any such Authorization or to make any such filing or notice would not have a Material Adverse Effect. Each such Authorization is valid and in full force and effect and the Company and each of its subsidiaries is in compliance with all the terms and conditions thereof and with the rules and regulations of the governmental authorities and governing bodies having jurisdiction with respect thereto; and no event has occurred (including, without limitation, the receipt of any notice from any governmental authority or governing body) which allows or, after notice or lapse of time or both, would allow, revocation, suspension or termination of any such Authorization or results or, after notice or lapse of time or both, would result in any other impairment of the rights of the holder of any such Authorization; and such Authorizations contain no restrictions that are unduly burdensome to the Company or any of its subsidiaries, except where such failure to be valid and in full force and effect or to be in compliance, the occurrence of any such

7 event or the presence of any such restriction would not, individually or in the aggregate, have a Material Adverse Effect. (t) The Company and each of its subsidiaries own or possess adequate rights to use all material patents, patent rights, patent applications, trademarks, service marks, trade names, trademark registrations, service mark registrations, copyrights, inventions, know-how (including trade secrets and other unpatented and/or unpatentable proprietary of confidential information, systems or procedures) and licenses necessary for the conduct of their respective businesses and have no reason to believe that the conduct of their respective businesses will conflict with, and neither the Company nor any of its subsidiaries has received any notice of infringement of asserted rights of others with respect to any of such intellectual property which, individually or in the aggregate, if the subject of an unfavorable decision, ruling or finding, would have a Material Adverse Effect. (u) None of the Company and its subsidiaries is involved in any strike, job action or labor dispute with any group of employees that might be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect, and, to the Company's knowledge, no such action or dispute is threatened. (v) The Company and each of its subsidiaries is in compliance in all material respects with all presently applicable provisions of the Employee Retirement Income Security Act of 1974, as amended, and the regulations and published interpretations thereunder (collectively, "ERISA"); no "reportable event" (as defined in ERISA) has occurred with respect to any "pension plan" (as defined in ERISA) for which the Company would have any liability; the Company has not incurred and does not expect to incur liability under (i) Title IV of ERISA with respect to termination of, or withdrawal from, any "pension plan" or (ii) Sections 412 or 4971 of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended, including the regulations and published interpretations thereunder (collectively, the "Internal Revenue Code"); and each "pension plan" for which the Company would have any liability that is intended to be qualified under Section 401(a) of the Internal Revenue Code is so qualified in all material respects and nothing has occurred, whether by action or by failure to act, which would cause the loss of such qualification. (w) The Company and each of its subsidiaries has filed all federal, state, local and foreign income and franchise tax returns required to be filed through the date hereof and has paid all taxes (including withholding taxes, penalties and interest, assessments, fees and other charges) due thereon; and no tax deficiency has been determined adversely to the Company or any of its subsidiaries which has had (nor does the Company have any knowledge of any tax deficiency which, if determined adversely to the Company or any of its subsidiaries, might have) a Material Adverse Effect. (x) Since the date as of which information is given in the Prospectus through the date hereof, and except as described in the Prospectus, the Company has not (i) issued or granted any securities, other than pursuant to the Company's stock option and employee stock purchase plans, (ii) incurred any liability or obligation, direct or

8 contingent, other than liabilities and obligations which were incurred in the ordinary course of business and which are not material, (iii) entered into any transaction not in the ordinary course of business or (iv) declared or paid any dividend on any of its capital stock. (y) The Company (i) makes and keeps accurate books and records and (ii) maintains internal accounting controls which provide reasonable assurance that (A) transactions are executed in accordance with management's authorization, (B) transactions are recorded and reported to the Company's management as necessary to permit preparation of its financial statements in conformity with United States generally accepted accounting principles and to maintain accountability for its assets, (C) access to its assets is permitted only in accordance with management's authorization and (D) the reported accountability for its assets is compared with existing assets at reasonable intervals and appropriate action is taken with respect to any differences. (z) Neither the Company nor any of its subsidiaries, nor any director, officer, agent, employee or other person associated with or acting on behalf of the Company or any of its subsidiaries, has used any corporate funds for any unlawful contribution, gift, entertainment or other unlawful expense relating to political activity; made any direct or indirect unlawful payment to any foreign or domestic government official or employee from corporate funds; violated or is in violation of any provision of the Foreign Corrupt Practices Act of 1977, as amended; or made any bribe, rebate, payoff, influence payment, kickback or other unlawful payment. (aa) There has been no storage, disposal, generation, manufacture, refinement, transportation, handling or treatment of toxic wastes, medical wastes, hazardous wastes or hazardous substances by the Company or any of its subsidiaries (or, to the knowledge of the Company, any of their predecessors in interest) at, upon or from any of the property now or previously owned or leased by the Company or its subsidiaries in violation of any applicable law, ordinance, rule, regulation, order, judgment, decree or permit or which would require remedial action under any applicable law, ordinance, rule, regulation, order, judgment, decree or permit, except for any violation or remedial action which would not have, or could not be reasonably likely to have, a Material Adverse Effect; there has been no material spill, discharge, leak, emission, injection, escape, dumping or release of any kind onto such property or into the environment surrounding such property of any toxic wastes, medical wastes, solid wastes, hazardous wastes or hazardous substances due to or caused by the Company or any of its subsidiaries or with respect to which the Company or any of its subsidiaries have knowledge, except for any such spill, discharge, leak, emission, injection, escape, dumping or release which would not have or would not be reasonably likely to have a Material Adverse Effect; and the terms "hazardous wastes", "toxic wastes", "hazardous substances" and "medical wastes" shall have the meanings specified in any applicable local, state, federal and foreign laws or regulations with respect to environmental protection. (bb) This Agreement has been duly authorized, executed and delivered by the Company.

9 (cc) The Company has all necessary power and authority to issue and deliver the Securities to be sold by the Company to the Underwriters hereunder, such Securities have been duly authorized by the Company and when such Securities are issued and delivered to and paid for by the Underwriters pursuant to this Agreement on the applicable Delivery Date, such Securities will be duly and validly issued, fully paid and non-assessable; the Securities to be sold by the Selling Stockholders to the Underwriters hereunder have been duly and validly issued and are fully paid and non-assessable; and the Securities will conform, when issued, in all material respects to the description thereof contained in the Prospectus. (dd) The execution, delivery and performance by the Company of this Agreement, the issuance of the Securities to be sold by the Company to the Underwriters hereunder, the compliance by the Company with all the provisions hereof and the consummation of the transactions contemplated hereby will not (i) conflict with or result in a breach or violation of any of the terms or provisions of, or constitute a default under, any material indenture, mortgage, deed of trust, loan agreement, lease or other agreement or instrument to which the Company or any of its subsidiaries is a party or by which the Company or any of its subsidiaries is bound or to which any of the property or assets of the Company or any of its subsidiaries is subject, (ii) result in any violation of the provisions of the charter or by-laws of the Company or any of its subsidiaries or any statute or any order, rule or regulation of any court or governmental agency or body having jurisdiction over the Company or any of its subsidiaries or any of their properties or assets, (iii) result in the imposition or creation of (or the obligation to create or impose) a Lien under any agreement or instrument to which the Company or any of its subsidiaries is a party or by which the Company or any of its subsidiaries or their respective properties or assets is bound or (iv) result in the suspension, termination or revocation of any Authorization of the Company or any of its subsidiaries or any other impairment of the rights of the holder of any such Authorization. (ee) Except (i) with respect to the registration of the Securities under the Securities Act, (ii) as required by applicable state securities or "blue sky" and foreign laws, (iii) approval by the National Association of Securities Dealers, Inc. and (iv) for such consents, approvals, authorizations, orders, filings or registrations which have been obtained or made, no consent, approval, authorization or order of, or filing or registration with, any court or governmental agency or body having jurisdiction over the Company or any of its subsidiaries or any of their properties or assets is required for the execution, delivery and performance of this Agreement by the Company, the issuance of the Securities to be sold by the Company and the consummation of the transactions contemplated hereby. (ff) Neither the Company nor any subsidiary is or, as of the applicable Delivery Date after giving effect to the issuance of the Securities and the application of the net proceeds therefrom as set forth in the Prospectus, will be an "investment company" as defined, and subject to regulation, under the Investment Company Act of 1940, as amended, and the rules and regulations of the Commission thereunder (collectively, the "Investment Company Act").

10 (gg) Neither the Company, nor to its knowledge, any of its Affiliates (as defined in Rule 501(b) of Regulation D, an "Affiliate"), has taken, directly or indirectly, any action (A) designed to cause or result in, or which has constituted or which might reasonably be expected to constitute, the stabilization or manipulation of the price of the Securities to facilitate the sale or resale of such securities or (B) prohibited by Regulation M under the Securities Act. (hh) All indebtedness of the Company that will be repaid with the proceeds of the issuance and sale of the Securities was incurred for proper purposes and in good faith and the Company was, at the time of the incurrence of such indebtedness that will be repaid with the proceeds of the issuance and sale of the Securities, and will be on the Delivery Date (after giving effect to the application of the proceeds from the issuance of the Securities) solvent, and had at the time of the incurrence of such indebtedness that will be repaid with the proceeds of the issuance and sale of the Securities and will have on the applicable Delivery Date (after giving effect to the application of the proceeds from the issuance of the Securities) sufficient capital for carrying on its business and was, at the time of the incurrence of such indebtedness that will be repaid with the proceeds of the issuance and sale of the Securities, and will be on the applicable Delivery Date (after giving effect to the application of the proceeds from the issuance of the Securities) able to pay its debts as they mature. Each certificate signed by any officer of the Company and delivered to the Underwriters or counsel to the Underwriters shall be deemed to be a representation and warranty by the Company to the Underwriters as to the matters covered thereby. 2. Representations, Warranties and Agreements of the Selling Stockholders. (a) Each Selling Stockholder, severally and not jointly, represents and warrants to, and agrees with the Underwriters that: (a) The Selling Stockholder has, and immediately prior to the applicable Delivery Date (as defined in Section 5 below) the Selling Stockholder will have, good and valid title to the Securities to be sold by the Selling Stockholder hereunder on such date, free and clear of all Liens; and upon delivery of such shares and payment therefor pursuant hereto, good and valid title to such shares, free and clear of all Liens, will pass to the several Underwriters. (b) The Selling Stockholder has placed in custody under a custody agreement (the "Custody Agreement") with American Stock Transfer & Trust Company, as custodian (the "Custodian"), for delivery, in accordance with the Custody Agreement, under this Agreement, certificates in negotiable form (with signature guaranteed by a commercial bank or trust company having an office or correspondent in the United States or a member firm of the New York or American Stock Exchanges) representing the Securities to be sold by the Selling Stockholder hereunder. (c) The Selling Stockholder has duly and irrevocably executed and delivered a power of attorney (the "Power of Attorney" and, together with all other similar instruments executed by the other Selling Stockholders, the "Powers of

11 Attorney") appointing the persons named therein as attorneys-in-fact, with full power of substitution, and with full authority (exercisable by any one or more of them) to execute and deliver this Agreement on such Selling Stockholder's behalf and to take such other action as may be necessary or desirable to carry out the provisions hereof on behalf of the Selling Stockholder, in accordance with the Custody Agreement and the applicable Power of Attorney. (d) The Selling Stockholder has all necessary right, power and authority to enter into this Agreement, the Power of Attorney and the Custody Agreement and the execution, delivery and performance of this Agreement, the Power of Attorney and the Custody Agreement by, or on behalf of, the Selling Stockholder and the consummation by the Selling Stockholder of the transactions contemplated hereby and thereby will not (A) conflict with or result in a breach or violation of any of the terms or provisions of, or constitute a default under, any indenture, mortgage, deed of trust, loan agreement, lease, pledge or other agreement or instrument to which the Selling Stockholder is a party or by which the Selling Stockholder is bound or to which any of the property or assets of the Selling Stockholder is subject that could reasonably be expected to impair the Selling Stockholder's ability to perform its obligations hereunder, or (B) result in any violation of any statute or any order, rule or regulation of any court or governmental agency or body having jurisdiction over the Selling Stockholder or the property or assets of the Selling Stockholder. (e) Except (i) with respect to the registration of the Securities under the Securities Act, (ii) as required by applicable state securities or "blue sky" laws and (iii) for such consents, approvals, authorizations, orders, filings or registrations which have been obtained or made, no consent, approval, authorization or order of, or filing or registration with, any court or governmental agency or body having jurisdiction over the Selling Stockholder or any of its properties or assets is required for the execution, delivery and performance of this Agreement, the Power of Attorney or the Custody Agreement by the Selling Stockholder and the consummation by the Selling Stockholder of the transactions contemplated hereby and thereby. (f) The Registration Statement, as of the Effective Date, did not contain an untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state a material fact required to be stated therein or necessary to make the statements therein not misleading, and the Prospectus and any amendment or supplement thereto, as of their respective dates and as of the applicable Delivery Date (as defined in Section 5 below) did not and do not contain an untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state a material fact necessary to make the statements therein, in light of the circumstances under which they were made, not misleading; provided that the Selling Stockholder makes no representation or warranty as to information contained in or omitted from the Registration Statement or the Prospectus in reliance upon and in conformity with written information furnished to the Company by or on behalf of any Underwriter specifically for inclusion therein (which information is described in Section 10(f)); and provided further that this paragraph (d) shall apply to such Selling Stockholder only to the extent that the statements or omissions from the Registration Statement or the Prospectus were based on written information provided by

12 such Selling Stockholder specifically for inclusion therein (which information is described in Section 10(g)). (g) The Selling Stockholder has not taken and will not take, directly or indirectly, any action (A) designed to or which has constituted or which might reasonably be expected to cause or result in the stabilization or manipulation of the price of any security of the Company to facilitate the sale or resale of the Securities or (B) prohibited by Regulation M under the Securities Act. (h) Each Selling Stockholder is not prompted to sell shares of Common Stock by any material, non-public information concerning the Company that is not set forth or incorporated by reference in the Registration Statement and the Prospectus. Each certificate signed by or on behalf of a Selling Stockholder and delivered to the Underwriters or counsel to the Underwriters shall be deemed to be a representation and warranty by such Selling Stockholder to the Underwriters as to the matters covered thereby. 3. Purchase of the Securities by the Underwriters. On the basis of the representations and warranties contained in, and subject to the terms and conditions of, this Agreement, the Company agrees to issue and sell 2,100,000 shares of the Firm Securities and each Selling Stockholder hereby agrees to sell the number of shares of the Firm Securities set forth opposite its name in Schedule II hereto, severally and not jointly, to the several Underwriters and each of the Underwriters, severally and not jointly, agrees to purchase the number of shares of the Firm Securities set forth opposite that Underwriter's name in Schedule I hereto. Each Underwriter shall be obligated to purchase from the Company, and from each Selling Stockholder, that number of shares of the Firm Securities which represents the same proportion of the number of shares of the Firm Securities to be sold by the Company, and by each Selling Stockholder, as the number of shares of the Firm Securities set forth opposite the name of such Underwriter in Schedule I represents of the total number of shares of the Firm Securities to be purchased by all of the Underwriters pursuant to this Agreement. The respective purchase obligations of the Underwriters with respect to the Firm Securities shall be rounded among the Underwriters to avoid fractional shares, as the Representatives may determine. In addition, the Company hereby grants to the Underwriters an option to purchase up to 318,295 shares of Option Securities. Such option is granted for the purpose of covering over-allotments in the sale of Firm Securities and is exercisable as provided in Section 5 hereof. Shares of Option Securities shall be purchased severally for the account of the Underwriters in proportion to the number of shares of Firm Securities set forth opposite the name of such Underwriters in Schedule I hereto. The respective purchase obligations of each Underwriter with respect to the Option Securities shall be adjusted by the Representatives so that no Underwriter shall be obligated to purchase Option Securities other than in 100 share amounts. The price of both the Firm Securities and any Option Securities shall be $____ per share.

13 Neither the Company nor any Selling Stockholder shall be obligated to deliver any of the Securities to be delivered on any Delivery Date (as defined in Section 5 below), except upon payment for all the Securities to be purchased on such Delivery Date as provided herein. 4. Offering of Securities by the Underwriters. Upon authorization by the Representatives of the release of the Securities, the several Underwriters propose to offer the Securities for sale upon the terms and conditions set forth in the Prospectus. 5. Delivery of and Payment for the Securities. Delivery of and payment for the Firm Securities shall be made at the offices of Piper Rudnick LLP, 6225 Smith Avenue, Baltimore, Maryland 21209 at 10:00 a.m., New York City time, on the third full business day following the date of this Agreement or at such other date or place as shall be determined by agreement between the Representatives and the Company. This date and time are referred to herein as the "First Delivery Date." On the First Delivery Date, the Company and each Selling Stockholder shall deliver or cause to be delivered certificates representing the Firm Securities to the Representatives or to the Custodian for the account of each Underwriter against payment to or upon the order of the Company and the Selling Stockholders of the purchase price by wire transfer in immediately available funds. Upon delivery, the Firm Securities shall be registered in such names and in such denominations as the Representatives shall request in writing not less than two full business days prior to the First Delivery Date. For the purpose of expediting the checking and packaging of the certificates for the Firm Securities, the Company and each Selling Stockholder shall make the certificates representing the Firm Securities available for inspection by the Representatives in New York, New York, not later than 2:00 p.m., New York City time, on the business day prior to the First Delivery Date. The option granted in Section 3 will expire 30 days after the date of this Agreement and may be exercised in whole or in part from time to time by written notice being given to the Company by the Representatives. Such notice shall set forth the aggregate number of shares of Option Securities as to which the option is being exercised, the names in which the shares of Option Securities are to be registered, the denominations in which the shares of Option Securities are to be issued and the date and time, as determined by the Representatives, when the shares of Option Securities are to be delivered; provided, however, that this date and time shall not be earlier than the First Delivery Date nor earlier than the second business day after the date on which the option shall have been exercised nor later than the fifth business day after the date on which the option shall have been exercised. The date and time the shares of Option Securities are delivered are sometimes referred to as an "Option Delivery Date" and the First Delivery Date and any Option Delivery Date are sometimes each referred to as a "Delivery Date". Delivery of and payment for the Option Securities shall be made at the place specified in the first sentence of the first paragraph of this Section 5 (or at such other place as shall be determined by agreement between the Representatives and the Company) at 10:00 a.m., New York City time, on such Option Delivery Date. On such Option Delivery Date, the Company shall deliver or cause to be delivered the certificates representing the Option Securities to the Representatives for the account of each Underwriter against payment to or upon the order of the Company of the purchase price by wire transfer in immediately available funds. Upon delivery, the Option Securities shall be registered in such names and in such denominations as

14 the Representatives shall request in the aforesaid written notice. For the purpose of expediting the checking and packaging of the certificates for the Option Securities, the Company shall make the certificates representing the Option Securities available for inspection by the Representatives in New York, New York, not later than 2:00 p.m., New York City time, on the business day prior to such Option Delivery Date. Time shall be of the essence, and delivery at the time and place specified pursuant to this Agreement is a further condition of the obligation of each Underwriter hereunder. 6. Further Agreements of the Company. The Company agrees: (a) To prepare the Prospectus in a form approved by the Representatives and to file such Prospectus pursuant to Rule 424(b) under the Securities Act not later than Commission's close of business on the second business day following the execution and delivery of this Agreement or, if applicable, such earlier time as may be required by Rule 430A(a)(3) under the Securities Act; to make no further amendment or any supplement to the Registration Statement or to the Prospectus prior to the last Delivery Date except as permitted herein; to advise the Representatives, promptly after it receives notice thereof, of the time when any amendment to the Registration Statement has been filed or becomes effective or any supplement to the Prospectus or any amended Prospectus has been filed and to furnish the Representatives with copies thereof; to file promptly all reports and any definitive proxy or information statements required to be filed by the Company with the Commission pursuant to Section 13(a), 13(c), 14 or 15(d) of the Exchange Act subsequent to the date of the Prospectus and for so long as the delivery of a prospectus is required in connection with the offering or sale of the Securities; to advise the Representatives, promptly after it receives notice thereof, of the issuance by the Commission of any stop order or of any order preventing or suspending the use of any Preliminary Prospectus or the Prospectus, of the suspension of the qualification of the Securities for offering or sale in any jurisdiction, of the initiation or threatening of any proceeding for any such purpose, or of any request by the Commission for the amending or supplementing of the Registration Statement or the Prospectus or for additional information; and, in the event of the issuance of any stop order or of any order preventing or suspending the use of any Preliminary Prospectus or the Prospectus or suspending any such qualification, to use promptly its best efforts to obtain its withdrawal; (b) To furnish promptly to each of the Representatives and to counsel to the Underwriters a signed copy of the Registration Statement as originally filed with the Commission, and each amendment thereto filed with the Commission, including all consents and exhibits filed therewith; (c) To deliver promptly to the Representatives such number of the following documents as the Representatives shall reasonably request: (i) conformed copies of the Registration Statement as originally filed with the Commission and each amendment thereto (excluding exhibits), (ii) each Preliminary Prospectus, the Prospectus and any amended or supplemented Prospectus and (iii) any documents incorporated by reference in the Prospectus (excluding exhibits thereto); and, if the delivery of a

15 prospectus is required at any time after the Effective Time in connection with the offering or sale of the Securities or any other securities relating thereto and if at such time any events shall have occurred as a result of which the Prospectus as then amended or supplemented would include an untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state any material fact necessary in order to make the statements therein, in the light of the circumstances under which they were made when such Prospectus is delivered, not misleading, or, if for any other reason it shall be necessary to amend or supplement the Prospectus or to file under the Exchange Act any document incorporated by reference in the Prospectus in order to comply with the Securities Act, to notify the Representatives and, upon their request, to file such documents and to prepare and furnish without charge to each Underwriter and to any dealer in securities as many copies as the Representatives may from time to time reasonably request of an amended or supplemented Prospectus which will correct such statement or omission or effect such compliance; (d) To file promptly with the Commission any amendment to the Registration Statement or the Prospectus or any supplement to the Prospectus that may, in the judgment of the Company or the Representatives, be required by the Securities Act or requested by the Commission; (e) Prior to filing with the Commission any amendment to the Registration Statement or supplement to the Prospectus, or any document incorporated by reference in the Prospectus, pursuant to Rule 424 of the Securities Act, to furnish a copy thereof to the Representatives and counsel to the Underwriters and obtain the consent of the Representatives to the filing, such consent not to be unreasonably withheld or delayed; (f) As soon as practicable after the Effective Date, to make generally available to the Company's security holders and to deliver to the Representatives an earnings statement of the Company and its subsidiaries (which need not be audited) complying with Section 11(a) of the Securities Act (including, at the option of the Company, Rule 158 of the Securities Act); (g) Promptly from time to time, to take such action as the Representatives may reasonably request to qualify the Securities for offering and sale under the securities laws of such jurisdictions as the Representatives may request and to comply with such laws so as to permit the continuance of sales and dealings therein in such jurisdictions for as long as may be necessary to complete the distribution of the Securities; provided that, in connection therewith, the Company shall not be required to qualify as a foreign corporation or to file a general consent to service of process in any jurisdiction in which the Company is not already so qualified or has not so consented; (h) For a period of two years following the First Delivery Date, to furnish to the Underwriters copies of all written materials furnished by the Company to its shareholders and all public reports and all reports and financial statements furnished by the Company to the principal national securities exchange upon which the Common Stock may be listed pursuant to requirements of or agreements with such exchange or to the Commission pursuant to the Exchange Act; provided, however, that the Company

16 shall not be required to provide the Underwriters with any such reports or similar forms that have been filed with the Commission by electronic transmission pursuant to EDGAR; (i) For a period of 90 days from the date hereof, not to, directly or indirectly, (1) announce an offering of, or file any registration statement with the Commission relating to, equity securities of the Company (other than the offering contemplated by this Agreement) or offer for sale, sell, pledge or otherwise dispose of (or enter into any transaction or device which is designed to, or could be expected to, result in the disposition or purchase by any person at any time in the future of) any shares of Common Stock or securities convertible into or exchangeable for Common Stock (other than the Securities and shares of Common Stock to be issued in the ordinary course under the Company's employee benefit plans, stock option plans, employee stock purchase plan or other employee compensation plans existing on the date hereof or pursuant to currently outstanding options, warrants or rights) or sell or grant options, warrants or rights with respect to any shares of Common Stock, securities convertible into or exchangeable for Common Stock or substantially similar securities (other than the grant of options, warrants or rights pursuant to option or other employee compensation plans existing on the date hereof), or (2) enter into any swap or other derivatives transaction that transfers to another, in whole or in part, any of the economic benefits or risks of ownership of such shares of Common Stock, whether any such transaction described in clause (1) or (2) above is to be settled by delivery of Common Stock or other securities, in cash or otherwise, without the prior written consent of Lehman Brothers Inc. on behalf of the Underwriters; and to cause each of the persons specified on Schedule III hereto to furnish to the Representatives, on or prior to the date hereof, a letter or letters, substantially in the form of Annex A hereto; (j) To cause the Securities to be approved by the New York Stock Exchange ("NYSE") for listing prior to the First Delivery Date; (k) Not to take, directly or indirectly, any action which is designed to stabilize or manipulate, or which constitutes or which might reasonably be expected to cause or result in stabilization or manipulation, of the price of any security of the Company in connection with the offering of the Securities; (l) To apply the net proceeds from the issuance and sale of the Securities as set forth under "Use of Proceeds" in the Prospectus; and (m) To take such steps as shall be necessary to ensure that neither the Company nor any of its subsidiaries shall become an "investment company" as defined, and subject to regulation, under the Investment Company Act. 7. Further Agreements of the Selling Stockholders. Each Selling Stockholder, severally and not jointly, agrees: (a) [reserved];

17 (b) That the Securities to be sold by the Selling Stockholder hereunder, which is represented by the certificates held in custody for the Selling Stockholder, is subject to the interest of the Underwriters and the other Selling Stockholders thereunder, that the arrangements made by the Selling Stockholder for such custody are to that extent irrevocable, and that the obligations of the Selling Stockholder hereunder shall not be terminated by any act of the Selling Stockholder, by operation of law, by the death or incapacity of any individual Selling Stockholder or, in the case of a trust, by the death or incapacity of any executor or trustee or the termination of such trust, or the occurrence of any other event, except as may be provided herein; (c) To deliver to the Representatives prior to the First Delivery Date a properly completed and executed United States Treasury Department Form W-8 (if the Selling Stockholder is a non-United States person) or Form W-9 (if the Selling Stockholder is a United States person); and (d) To cooperate with the Company and the Underwriters and to execute and deliver, or use its best efforts to cause to be executed and delivered, all such other instruments, and take all such other actions as such party may reasonably be requested to take by the Company and the Underwriters from time to time, in order to effectuate the sale of the Securities in the offering contemplated hereby. 8. Expenses. The Company agrees to pay the following expenses, whether or not the transactions contemplated by this Agreement are consummated or this Agreement is terminated: (a) the costs incident to the authorization, issuance, sale and delivery of the Securities and any taxes payable in that connection; (b) the costs incident to the preparation, printing and filing under the Securities Act of the Registration Statement, the Prospectus and any amendments and exhibits thereto; (c) the costs of distributing the Registration Statement as originally filed and each amendment thereto and any post-effective amendments thereto (including, exhibits), any Preliminary Prospectus, the Prospectus and any amendment or supplement to the Prospectus or any document incorporated by reference therein, all as provided in this Agreement; (d) the costs of producing and distributing this Agreement; (e) the cost of delivering and distributing the Custody Agreement and the Powers of Attorney; (f) the filing fees incident to securing the review by the NYSE and the National Association of Securities Dealers, Inc. of the terms of sale of the Securities and any applicable listing or other fees;

18 (g) the fees and expenses of qualifying the Securities under the securities laws of the several jurisdictions as provided in Section 6(g) and of preparing, printing and distributing a Canadian wrapper (including related fees and expenses of counsel to the Underwriters); (h) the costs and expenses of the Company relating to investor presentations on any "road show" undertaken in connection with the marketing of the offering of the Securities, including, without limitation, expenses associated with the production of road show slides and graphics, fees and expenses of any consultants engaged in connection with the road show presentations with the prior approval of the Company, travel and lodging expenses of the representatives and officers of the Company and any such consultants, and the cost of any aircraft chartered in connection with the road show; and (i) all other costs and expenses incident to the performance of the obligations of the Company and Selling Stockholders under this Agreement provided that, except as provided in this Section 8 and in Section 13 the Underwriters shall pay their own costs and expenses, including the fees and expenses of their counsel, and the Selling Stockholders shall pay the fees and expenses of their counsel and their attorneys-in-fact and any transfer taxes payable in connection with their respective sales of Stock to the Underwriters and reimburse the Company for their pro rata share of the fees and expenses paid by the Company in connection with the offering of the Stock, unless any such Selling Stockholder shall have agreed otherwise with the Company in which case the Company shall pay such Selling Shareholder's fees and expenses. 9. Conditions of Underwriters' Obligations. The several obligations of the Underwriters hereunder are subject to the accuracy, when made and on each Delivery Date, of the representations and warranties of the Company and the Selling Stockholders contained herein, to the performance by the Company and the Selling Stockholders of their respective obligations hereunder, and to each of the following additional terms and conditions: (a) The Prospectus shall have been timely filed with the Commission in accordance with Section 6(a); no stop order suspending the effectiveness of the Registration Statement or any part thereof shall have been issued and no proceeding for that purpose shall have been initiated or threatened by the Commission; and any request of the Commission for inclusion of additional information in the Registration Statement or the Prospectus or otherwise shall have been complied with. (b) No Underwriter shall have discovered and disclosed to the Company prior to or on such Delivery Date that the Registration Statement, the Prospectus or any amendment or supplement thereto, in the opinion of Simpson Thacher & Bartlett, counsel to the Underwriters, contains any untrue statement of any material fact or omits to state a material fact required to be stated therein or necessary in order to make the statements therein not misleading.

19 (c) All corporate proceedings and other legal matters incident to the authorization, form and validity of this Agreement, the Custody Agreement, the Powers of Attorney, the Registration Statement, the Prospectus, the Securities, and all other legal matters relating to the offering, issuance and sale of the Securities and the transactions contemplated hereby and thereby shall be reasonably satisfactory in all material respects to counsel to the Underwriters; and the Company and the Selling Stockholders shall have furnished to such counsel all documents and information that they may reasonably request to enable them to pass upon such matters. (d) Piper Rudnick LLP shall have furnished to the Representatives its written opinion, as counsel to the Company, addressed to the Underwriters and dated such Delivery Date, in form and substance reasonably satisfactory to the Representatives, to the effect that: (i) The Company and each of its subsidiaries have been duly formed and are validly existing as corporations or limited liability companies in good standing under the laws of their respective jurisdictions of formation, are duly qualified to do business and are in good standing as foreign corporations in each jurisdiction in which their respective ownership or lease of property or the conduct of their respective businesses requires such qualification (other than such jurisdictions where the failure to be so qualified or otherwise authorized to transact business would not reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect) and have all corporate power and authority necessary to own or hold their respective properties and conduct the businesses in which they are engaged. (ii) The Company has an authorized and issued capitalization as set forth in the Prospectus, and all of the issued shares of capital stock of the Company (including the Securities being delivered on such Delivery Date) have been duly and validly authorized and issued, are fully paid and non-assessable and conform to the description thereof contained in the Prospectus; and all of the issued shares of capital stock of each subsidiary of the Company have been duly and validly authorized and issued and are fully paid, non-assessable and are owned directly or indirectly by the Company, free and clear of all Liens other than those arising pursuant to the Credit Facility. (iii) There are no preemptive or other rights to subscribe for or to purchase, nor any restriction upon the voting or transfer of, any Securities pursuant to the Company's charter or by-laws or any agreement or other instrument known to such counsel. (iv) The Registration Statement was declared effective under the Securities Act as of the date and time specified in such opinion, the Prospectus was filed with the Commission pursuant to the subparagraph of Rule 424(b) of the Securities Act specified in such opinion on the date specified therein; and no stop order suspending the effectiveness of the Registration Statement has been issued and, to the knowledge of such counsel, no proceeding for that purpose is pending or threatened by the Commission.

20 (v) The Registration Statement and the Prospectus and any further amendments or supplements thereto made by the Company prior to such Delivery Date, the Incorporated Documents and any further amendment or supplement to any such incorporated document made by the Company prior to such Delivery Date (other than the financial statements and related schedules therein, as to which such counsel need express no opinion), when they became effective or were filed with the Commission, as the case may be, complied as to form in all material respects with the requirements of the Securities Act and the Exchange Act, as applicable. (vi) To such counsel's knowledge, there are no contracts or other documents which are required to be set forth in the Prospectus or filed as exhibits to the Registration Statement by the Securities Act which have not been set forth or filed as exhibits to the Registration Statement or incorporated therein by reference. (vii) The Company has all necessary corporate right, power and authority to execute and deliver this Agreement and to perform its obligations thereunder and to issue, sell and deliver the Securities to the Underwriters. (viii) This Agreement has been duly authorized, executed and delivered by the Company. (ix) The Securities have been duly authorized by the Company and when the Securities are issued and delivered to and paid for by the Underwriters pursuant to this Agreement on the applicable Delivery Date, such Securities will be duly and validly issued, fully paid and non-assessable; the Securities will conform, when issued, in all material respects to the description thereof contained in the Prospectus. (x) The statements made in the Prospectus under the caption "Description of Capital Stock", insofar as they purport to constitute summaries of the terms of the Company's capital stock, constitute accurate summaries of the terms of such capital stock in all material respects. (xi) The statements made in the Prospectus under the caption "Description of Capital Stock - General, - Common Stock and - Anti-Takeover Provisions of the Maryland General Corporation Law", insofar as they purport to constitute summaries of the terms of the Company's charter or bylaws, the Maryland General Corporation Law, rules and regulations thereunder or contracts and other documents, constitute accurate summaries of the terms of such statutes, rules and regulations or contracts and other documents in all material respects. (xii) The statements made in the Prospectus under the caption "Certain United States Tax Considerations to Non-U.S. Holders" to Non-U.S. Holders, insofar as they purport to constitute summaries of matters of United States federal income tax law and regulations or legal conclusions with respect thereto,

21 constitute accurate summaries of the matters set forth therein in all material respects. (xiii) The execution, delivery and performance by the Company of the this Agreement, the issuance of the Securities to be sold by the Company, the compliance by the Company with all the provisions hereof and the consummation of the transactions contemplated hereby will not (A) conflict with or result in a breach or violation of any of the terms or provisions of, or constitute a default under, any material indenture, mortgage, deed of trust, loan agreement, lease or other agreement or instrument to which the Company or any of its subsidiaries is a party or by which the Company or any of its subsidiaries is bound or to which any of the material property or assets of the Company or any of its subsidiaries is subject or (B) result in any violation of the provisions of the charter or by-laws of the Company or any of its subsidiaries or any statute or any order, rule or regulation known to such counsel of any court or governmental agency or body having jurisdiction over the Company or any of its subsidiaries or any of their properties or assets. (xiv) Neither the Company nor any of its subsidiaries (i) is in violation of its charter or by-laws, (ii) to such counsel's knowledge is in default in any material respect, and no event has occurred which, with notice or lapse of time or both, would constitute such a default, in the due performance or observance of any term, covenant or condition contained in any material indenture, mortgage, deed of trust, loan agreement or other agreement or instrument to which it is a party or by which it is bound or to which any of its properties or assets is subject or (iii) is in violation in any material respect of any law, ordinance, governmental rule, regulation or court decree to which it or its property or assets may be subject or has failed to obtain any material license, permit, certificate, franchise or other governmental authorization or permit necessary to the ownership of its property or to the conduct of its business. (xv) No consent, approval, authorization or order of, or filing or registration with, any court or governmental agency or body having jurisdiction over the Company or any of its subsidiaries or any of their properties or assets is required for the execution, delivery and performance of the Agreement or any of the other documents to be entered into in connection with the issuance of the Securities by the Company and the consummation of the transactions contemplated hereby and thereby, except (A) for the registration of the Securities under the Securities Act, (B) such consents, approvals, authorizations, registrations or qualifications as may be required under applicable state securities laws in connection with the purchase and distribution of the Securities by the Underwriters and (C) for such consents, approvals, authorizations, orders, filings or registrations as have been obtained or made. (xvi) To the knowledge of such counsel, there are no contracts, agreements or understandings between the Company and any person granting such person the right to require the Company to file a registration statement under

22 the Securities Act with respect to any securities of the Company owned or to be owned by such person or to require the Company to include such securities in the Securities registered pursuant to the Registration Statement or in any securities being registered pursuant to any other registration statement filed by the Company under the Securities Act, except for such rights as have been exercised or waived in connection with the offering and sale of the Securities. (xvii) To the knowledge of such counsel, there are no legal or governmental proceedings pending or threatened to which the Company or any of its subsidiaries is a party or of which any property or assets of the Company or any of its subsidiaries is the subject which, if determined adversely to the Company, might have a Material Adverse Effect. (xviii) The Company is not, and assuming the application of the net proceeds from the sale of the Securities as set forth in the Prospectus, will not be, an "investment company" as defined, and subject to regulation, under the Investment Company Act. In rendering such opinion, such counsel may state that their opinion is limited to matters governed by the federal laws of the United States of America and the laws of the State of Maryland. In rendering such opinion, such counsel may rely upon a certificate of the Company in respect of matters of fact, provided that such counsel shall furnish a copy thereof to the Representatives and state that it believes that both the Underwriters and it are justified in relying upon such certificate. Such opinion shall also include a statement to the effect that (x) such counsel has acted as counsel to the Company in connection with the preparation of the Registration Statement, such counsel participated in conferences with officers and other representatives of the Company, the Company's independent accountants and the Underwriters and their counsel, at which the contents of the Registration Statement were discussed, and (y) based on the foregoing, no facts have come to the attention of such counsel which lead such counsel to believe that (I) the Registration Statement (except for the financial statements and financial and statistical data included or incorporated by reference therein, as to which such counsel need express no belief), as of the Effective Date, contained any untrue statement of a material fact or omitted to state a material fact required to be stated therein or necessary in order to make the statements therein not misleading, or that the Prospectus (except as stated above), as of its date and the applicable Delivery Date, contained or contains any untrue statement of a material fact or omitted or omits to state a material fact required to be stated therein or necessary in order to make the statements therein, in light of the circumstances under which they were made, not misleading or (II) any documents incorporated by reference in the Prospectus, when they were filed with the Commission contained an untrue statement of a material fact or omitted to state a material fact necessary in order to make the statements therein, in light of the circumstances under which they were made, not misleading. The opinion of Piper Rudnick LLP described in this Section 9(d) shall be rendered to the Representatives at the request of the Company and shall so state therein. (e) The respective counsel for each of the Selling Stockholders set forth on Schedule II hereto each shall have furnished to the Representatives their written

23 opinion, as counsel to each of the Selling Stockholders for whom they are acting as counsel, addressed to the Underwriters in form and substance reasonably satisfactory to the Representatives dated such Delivery Date, to the effect that: (i) Immediately prior to the time of delivery of the Securities to the Underwriters, the Selling Stockholder is the sole registered owner of the Securities to be sold by it, has all necessary power and authority to sell such Securities and, upon payment for and delivery of such Securities in accordance with this Agreement, the Underwriters will acquire all of the rights of the Selling Stockholder in such Securities and will also acquire their interest in such Securities free of any adverse claim; (ii) This Agreement has been duly authorized, executed and delivered by or on behalf of the Selling Stockholder; (iii) A Power of Attorney and a Custody Agreement have been duly executed and delivered by the Selling Stockholder and constitute valid and binding agreements of such Selling Stockholder in accordance with their terms; (iv) The execution, delivery and performance by the Selling Stockholder of the this Agreement, the Power of Attorney and the Custody Agreement, the compliance by the Selling Stockholder with all the provisions hereof and thereof and the consummation by the Selling Stockholder of the transactions contemplated hereby and thereby will not (A) conflict with or result in a breach or violation of any of the terms or provisions of, or constitute a default under, any indenture, mortgage, deed of trust, loan agreement, lease or other agreement or instrument to which the Selling Stockholder is a party or by which the Selling Stockholder is bound or to which any of the property or assets of the Selling Stockholder is subject that could reasonably be expected to impair the Selling Stockholder's ability to perform its obligations hereunder or (B) result in any violation of any statute or any order, rule or regulation known to such counsel of any court or governmental agency or body having jurisdiction over the Selling Stockholder or any of its properties or assets; and (v) No consent, approval, authorization or order of, or filing or registration with, or qualification of or with, any governmental agency or body or any court or agency acting pursuant to any statute or law is required for the issue and sale of the Securities by the Selling Stockholder and the compliance by the Selling Stockholder with all of the provisions of this Agreement, except for (A) the registration of the Securities under the Securities Act, (B) such consents, approvals, authorizations, registrations or qualifications as may be required under the Exchange Act and applicable state securities or blue sky laws in connection with the purchase and distribution of the Securities by the Underwriters and (C) for such consents, approvals, authorizations, orders, filings or registrations as have been obtained or made.

24 In rendering the opinions in Section 9(e)(i) above, counsel to each Selling Stockholder may rely upon a certificate of such Selling Stockholder in respect of matters of fact as to ownership of and the absence of adverse claims regarding the Securities sold by such Selling Stockholder. The opinion of counsel to each Selling Stockholder described in this Section 9(e) shall be rendered to the Representatives at the request of such Selling Stockholder and shall so state therein. (f) Simpson Thacher & Bartlett shall have furnished to the Underwriters its written opinion, as counsel to the Underwriters, addressed to the Underwriters and dated such Delivery Date, in form and substance reasonably satisfactory to the Underwriters. In rendering such opinion, as to matters of Maryland law, Simpson Thacher & Bartlett shall be entitled to rely on the opinion of Piper Rudnick LLP described in Section 9(d) above. (g) At the time of execution of this Agreement, the Representatives shall have received from each of (i) Ernst & Young and (ii) Deloitte & Touche LLP (collectively, the "Accountants") a letter or letters, in form and substance reasonably satisfactory to the Representatives, addressed to the Underwriters and dated the date hereof (i) confirming that they are independent public accountants within the meaning of the Securities Act and are in compliance with the applicable requirements relating to the qualification of accountants under Rule 2-01 of Regulation S-X of the Commission and (ii) stating, as of the date hereof (or, with respect to matters involving changes or developments since the respective dates as of which specified financial information is given in the Prospectus, as of a date not more than five days prior to the date hereof), the conclusions and findings of such firm with respect to the financial information (including without limitation pro forma financial information) and other matters ordinarily covered by accountants' "comfort letters" to underwriters in connection with registered public offerings. (h) With respect to the letters of the Accountants referred to in the preceding paragraph and delivered to the Representatives concurrently with the execution of this Agreement (each an "initial comfort letter"), the Company shall have furnished to the Representatives a letter (each a "bring-down comfort letter") of each of such Accountants, addressed to the Underwriters and dated such Delivery Date (i) confirming that they are independent public accountants within the meaning of the Securities Act and are in compliance with the applicable requirements relating to the qualification of accountants under Rule 2-01 of Regulation S-X of the Commission, (ii) stating, as of the date of the bring-down letter (or, with respect to matters involving changes or developments since the respective dates as of which specified financial information is given in the Prospectus, as of a date not more than five days prior to the date of the bring-down letter), the conclusions and findings of such firm with respect to the financial information and other matters covered by the initial letters and (iii) confirming in all material respects the conclusions and findings set forth in the initial comfort letters. (i) The Company shall have furnished to the Representatives a certificate, dated such Delivery Date, of its chief executive officer and its chief financial officer, in form and substance reasonably satisfactory to the Underwriters, stating that:

25 (i) the representations, warranties and agreements of the Company in Section 1 of this Agreement are true and correct as of such Delivery Date; and the Company has complied in all material respects with all its agreements contained herein to be performed prior to or on such Delivery Date; and the conditions set forth in Sections 9(a) and 9(k) have been fulfilled; (ii) since the respective dates as of which information is given in the Prospectus, other than as set forth in the Prospectus (exclusive of any amendments or supplements thereto subsequent to the date of this Agreement filed in accordance with the terms of this Agreement), (A) there has not occurred any change or any development that could reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect, (B) there has not been any change in the capital stock, the short-term debt, or the long-term debt of the Company or any of its subsidiaries that could reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect, (C) neither the Company nor any of its subsidiaries has incurred any material liability or obligation, direct or contingent, (D) a Material Loss has not occurred, (E) the Company has not declared or paid any dividend on its capital stock, except for dividends declared in the ordinary course of business and consistent with past practice, and (F) except as set forth in the Prospectus, neither the Company nor any of its subsidiaries has entered into any transaction or agreement (whether or not in the ordinary course of business) material to the Company and its subsidiaries taken as a whole; and (iii) they have carefully examined the Registration Statement and the Prospectus and, in their opinion, (A) the Registration Statement, as of the Effective Date, conformed in all material respects with the requirements of the Securities Act and did not contain any untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state a material fact required to be stated therein or necessary to make the statements therein not misleading, (B) the Prospectus, as of its date and as of the applicable Delivery Date, conformed and conforms in all material respects with the requirements of the Securities Act and did not and does not contain any untrue statement of a material fact and did not and does not omit to state a material fact required to be stated therein or necessary to make the statements therein, in light of the circumstances under which they were made, not misleading and (C) since the Effective Date no event has occurred which should have been set forth in a supplement or amendment to the Registration Statement or the Prospectus. (j) Each Selling Stockholder (or one or more attorneys-in-fact on behalf of such Selling Stockholder) shall have furnished to the Representatives on the Initial Delivery Date, a certificate, dated such Delivery Date, signed by, or on behalf of, such Selling Stockholder stating that the representations, warranties and agreements of such Selling Stockholder contained herein are true and correct as of such Delivery Date and that such Selling Stockholder has complied in all material respects with all agreements contained herein to be performed by such Selling Stockholder at or prior to such Delivery Date.

26 (k) The NYSE shall have approved the Securities for listing, subject only to official notice of issuance. (l) The Representatives shall have received from each of the persons specified on Schedule III hereto an executed lock-up letter agreement contemplated by Section 6(i) hereof. (m) Neither the Company nor any of its subsidiaries shall have sustained since the date of the latest audited financial statements included in the Prospectus (A) any Material Loss, otherwise than as described or contemplated in the Prospectus, or (B) since such date there shall not have been any change in the capital stock, short-term debt or long-term debt of the Company or any of its subsidiaries or any change, or any development involving a prospective change, in or affecting the general affairs, management, financial position, prospects, stockholders' equity or results of operations of the Company and its subsidiaries, otherwise than as described or contemplated in the Prospectus, the effect of which, in any such case described in clause (A) or (B), is, in the judgment of the Representatives, so material and adverse as to make it impracticable or inadvisable to proceed with the public offering or the delivery of the Securities being delivered on the applicable Delivery Date on the terms and in the manner contemplated in the Prospectus and this Agreement. (n) Subsequent to the execution and delivery of this Agreement, there shall not have occurred any of the following: (i) trading in securities generally on the New York Stock Exchange or the American Stock Exchange or the NASDAQ or in the over-the-counter market, or trading in any securities of the Company on any exchange or in the over-the-counter market, shall have been suspended or the settlement of such trading generally shall have been materially disrupted or minimum prices shall have been established on any such exchange or such market by the Commission, by such exchange or by any other regulatory body or governmental authority having jurisdiction, (ii) a banking moratorium shall have been declared by Federal or state authorities of the United States, (iii) the United States shall have become engaged in hostilities, there shall have been an escalation in hostilities involving the United States, there shall have been a declaration of a national emergency or war by the United States or there shall have occurred any other substantial, national or international, calamity or crisis (iv) there shall have occurred such a material adverse change in general domestic or international economic, political or financial conditions, including without limitation as a result of terrorist activities, or the effect of international conditions on the financial markets in the United States shall be such, as to make it, in the judgment of the Representatives, impracticable or inadvisable to proceed with the public offering or delivery of the Securities being delivered on such Delivery Date on the terms and in the manner contemplated in the Prospectus. The Company and the Selling Stockholders shall have furnished to the Representatives such further information, certificates and documents as the Representatives may reasonably request to evidence compliance with the conditions set forth in this Section 9. All opinions, letters, evidence and certificates mentioned above or elsewhere in this Agreement shall

27 be deemed to be in compliance with the provisions hereof only if they are in form and substance reasonably satisfactory to counsel for the Underwriters. 10. Indemnification and Contribution. (a) The Company shall indemnify and hold harmless each Underwriter, its respective directors, officers and employees and each person, if any, who controls any Underwriter within the meaning of the Securities Act, and each Selling Stockholder from and against any loss, claim, damage or liability, joint or several, or any action in respect thereof (including, but not limited to, any loss, claim, damage, liability or action relating to purchases and sales of the Securities), to which that Underwriter, director, officer, employee or controlling person or Selling Stockholder may become subject, under the Securities Act or otherwise, insofar as such loss, claim, damage, liability or action arises out of, or is based upon, (i) any untrue statement or alleged untrue statement of a material fact contained in any (A) Preliminary Prospectus, the Registration Statement or the Prospectus or in any amendment or supplement thereto, (B) any blue sky application or other document prepared or executed by the Company (or based upon any written information furnished by the Company for such purpose) filed in any jurisdiction specifically for the purpose of qualifying any or all of the Securities under the securities laws of any state or other jurisdiction (such application, document or information being hereinafter called a "Blue Sky Application"), or (C) in any materials or information provided to investors by, or with the approval of, the Company in connection with the marketing of the offering of the Securities ("Marketing Materials"), including any roadshow or investor presentations made to investors by the Company (whether in person or electronically), (ii) the omission or alleged omission to state in any Preliminary Prospectus, the Registration Statement, the Prospectus, or in any amendment or supplement thereto, in any Blue Sky Application or in any Marketing Materials any material fact required to be stated therein or necessary to make the statements therein not misleading or (iii) any act or failure to act or any alleged act or failure to act by any Underwriter or Selling Stockholder in connection with, or relating in any manner to, the Securities or the offering contemplated hereby, and which is included as part of or referred to in any loss, claim, damage, liability or action arising out of or based upon matters covered by clause (i) or (ii) above (provided that, the Company shall not be liable under this clause (iii) to the extent that it is determined in a final judgment by a court of competent jurisdiction that such loss, claim, damage, liability or action resulted directly from any such acts or failures to act undertaken or omitted to be taken by such Underwriter or such Selling Stockholder through its gross negligence or willful misconduct), and shall reimburse each Underwriter, each such director, officer, employee or controlling person and each Selling Stockholder promptly upon demand for any legal or other expenses reasonably incurred by that Underwriter, director, officer, employee or controlling person or Selling Stockholder in connection with investigating or defending or preparing to defend against any such loss, claim, damage, liability or action as such expenses are incurred; provided, however, that the Company shall not be liable to any Underwriter in any such case to the extent that any such loss, claim, damage, liability or action arises out of, or is based upon, any untrue statement or alleged untrue statement or omission or alleged omission made in any Preliminary Prospectus, the Registration

28 Statement or the Prospectus, or in any such amendment or supplement, in reliance upon and in conformity with the written information concerning such Underwriter furnished to the Company through the Representatives by or on behalf of any Underwriter specifically for inclusion therein, which information consists solely of the information specified in Section 10(f); provided, further, that the Company shall not be liable in any such case to a Selling Stockholder to the extent that any such loss, claim, damage, liability or action arises out of, or is based upon, any untrue statement or alleged untrue statement or omission or alleged omission made in any Preliminary Prospectus, the Registration Statement or the Prospectus, or in any such amendment or supplement, in reliance upon and in conformity with the written information furnished to the Company by such Selling Stockholder specifically for inclusion therein, which information consists solely of the information specified in Section 10(g). The foregoing indemnity agreement is in addition to any liability which the Company may otherwise have to any Underwriter, any director, officer, employee or controlling person of any Underwriter or any Selling Stockholder. (b) Each of the Selling Stockholders, severally in proportion to the number of shares of Securities to be sold by each of them hereunder, shall indemnify and hold harmless each Underwriter, its directors, officers and employees, and each person, if any, who controls any Underwriter within the meaning of the Securities Act, from and against any loss, claim, damage or liability, joint or several, or any action in respect thereof (including, but not limited to, any loss, claim, damage, liability or action relating to purchases and sales of the Securities), to which that Underwriter, director, officer, employee or controlling person may become subject, under the Securities Act or otherwise, insofar as such loss, claim, damage, liability or action arises out of, or is based upon, (i) any untrue statement or alleged untrue statement of a material fact contained in any Preliminary Prospectus, the Registration Statement or the Prospectus or in any amendment or supplement thereto or (ii) the omission or alleged omission to state in any Preliminary Prospectus, the Registration Statement or the Prospectus, or in any amendment or supplement thereto, any material fact required to be stated therein or necessary to make the statements therein not misleading, but in each case only to the extent that the untrue statement or alleged untrue statement or omission or alleged omission was made in reliance upon and in conformity with written information furnished to the Company by such Selling Stockholder specifically for inclusion therein, which information is limited to the information set forth in Section 10(g), and shall reimburse each Underwriter and any such director, officer, employee or controlling person for any legal or other expenses reasonably incurred by such Underwriter or any such director, officer, employee or controlling person in connection with investigating or defending or preparing to defend against any such loss, claim, damage, liability or action as such expenses are incurred; provided, however, that the Selling Stockholders shall not be liable in any such case to the extent that any such loss, claim, damage, liability or action arises out of, or is based upon, any untrue statement or alleged untrue statement or omission or alleged omission made in any Preliminary Prospectus, the Registration Statement or the Prospectus, or in any such amendment or supplement, in reliance upon and in conformity with written information concerning such Underwriter furnished to the Company through the Representatives by or on behalf of any Underwriter specifically for inclusion therein, which information consists solely of the information specified in

29 Section 10(f). Notwithstanding any other provisions of this Agreement, the liability of each Selling Stockholder pursuant to the provisions of this Section 10 shall be limited to an amount equal to the aggregate purchase price, less underwriting discounts and commissions, received by such Selling Stockholder from the sale of Securities hereunder by such Selling Stockholder. The foregoing indemnity agreement is in addition to any liability that the Selling Stockholders may otherwise have to any Underwriter or to any director, officer, employee or controlling person of that Underwriter. (c) Each Underwriter, severally and not jointly, shall indemnify and hold harmless the Company, each Selling Stockholder, each of their respective directors, officers and employees, and each person, if any, who controls the Company or such Selling Stockholder within the meaning of the Securities Act, from and against any loss, claim, damage or liability, joint or several, or any action in respect thereof, to which the Company, such Selling Stockholder or any such director, officer, employee or controlling person may become subject, under the Securities Act or otherwise, insofar as such loss, claim, damage, liability or action arises out of, or is based upon, (i) any untrue statement or alleged untrue statement of a material fact contained in any Preliminary Prospectus, the Registration Statement or the Prospectus or in any amendment or supplement thereto or in any Blue Sky Application or (ii) the omission or alleged omission to state in any Preliminary Prospectus, the Registration Statement or the Prospectus, or in any amendment or supplement thereto or in any Blue Sky Application, any material fact required to be stated therein or necessary to make the statements therein not misleading, but in each case only to the extent that the untrue statement or alleged untrue statement or omission or alleged omission was made in reliance upon and in conformity with the written information concerning such Underwriter furnished to the Company and the Selling Stockholders through the Representatives by or on behalf of that Underwriter specifically for inclusion therein and set forth in Section 10(f), and shall reimburse the Company, each Selling Stockholder and any such director, officer, employee or controlling person promptly upon demand for any legal or other expenses reasonably incurred by the Company or such Selling Stockholder or any such director, officer, employee or controlling person in connection with investigating or defending or preparing to defend against any such loss, claim, damage, liability or action as such expenses are incurred. The foregoing indemnity agreement is in addition to any liability which any Underwriter may otherwise have to the Company, any Selling Stockholder or any such director, officer, employee or controlling person. (d) Promptly after receipt by an indemnified party under this Section 10 of notice of any claim or the commencement of any action, the indemnified party shall, if a claim in respect thereof is to be made against the indemnifying party under this Section 10, notify the indemnifying party in writing of the claim or the commencement of that action; provided, however, that the failure to notify the indemnifying party shall not relieve it from any liability which it may have under this Section 10 except to the extent it has been materially prejudiced by such failure; and provided, further, that the failure to notify the indemnifying party shall not relieve it from any liability which it may have to an indemnified party otherwise than under this Section 10. If any such claim or action shall be brought against an indemnified party, and it shall notify the indemnifying party

30 thereof, the indemnifying party shall be entitled to participate therein and, to the extent that it wishes, jointly with any other similarly notified indemnifying party, to assume the defense thereof with counsel reasonably satisfactory to the indemnified party. After notice from the indemnifying party to the indemnified party of its election to assume the defense of such claim or action, the indemnifying party shall not be liable to the indemnified party under this Section 10 for any legal or other expenses subsequently incurred by the indemnified party in connection with the defense thereof other than reasonable costs of investigation; provided, however, that the Representatives shall have the right to employ separate counsel to represent jointly the Representatives and those other Underwriters and their respective officers, employees and controlling persons who may be subject to liability arising out of any claim in respect of which indemnity may be sought by the Underwriters against the Company or any Selling Stockholder under this Section 10 if, in the reasonable judgment of the Representatives, it is advisable for the Representatives and such Underwriters, officers, employees and controlling persons to be jointly represented by separate counsel, and in that event the fees and expenses of such separate counsel shall be paid by the Company. No indemnifying party shall, (i) without the prior written consent of the indemnified parties (which consent shall not be unreasonably withheld), settle or compromise or consent to the entry of any judgment with respect to any pending or threatened claim, action, suit or proceeding in respect of which indemnification or contribution may be sought hereunder (whether or not the indemnified parties are actual or potential parties to such claim or action) unless such settlement, compromise or consent includes an unconditional release of each indemnified party from all liability arising out of such claim, action, suit or proceeding, or (ii) be liable for any settlement of any such action effected without its written consent (which consent shall not be unreasonably withheld), but if settled with its written consent or if there be a final judgment of the plaintiff in any such action, the indemnifying party agrees to indemnify and hold harmless any indemnified party from and against any loss or liability by reason of such settlement or judgment. (e) If the indemnification provided for in this Section 10 shall for any reason be unavailable or insufficient to hold harmless an indemnified party under Section 10(a), 10(b) or 10(c) in respect of any loss, claim, damage or liability, or any action in respect thereof, referred to therein, then each indemnifying party shall, in lieu of indemnifying such indemnified party, contribute to the amount paid or payable by such indemnified party as a result of such loss, claim, damage or liability, or action in respect thereof, (i) in such proportion as shall be appropriate to reflect the relative benefits received by the Company and the Selling Stockholders on the one hand and the Underwriters on the other from the offering of the Securities or (ii) if the allocation provided by clause (i) above is not permitted by applicable law, in such proportion as is appropriate to reflect not only the relative benefits referred to in clause (i) above but also the relative fault of the Company and the Selling Stockholders on the one hand and the Underwriters on the other with respect to the statements or omissions which resulted in such loss, claim, damage or liability, or action in respect thereof, as well as any other relevant equitable considerations. The relative benefits received by the Company and the Selling Stockholders on the one hand and the Underwriters on the other with respect to such offering shall be deemed to be in the same proportion as the total net proceeds from

31 the offering of the Securities purchased under this Agreement (before deducting expenses) received by the Company and the Selling Stockholders, on the one hand, and the total underwriting discounts and commissions received by the Underwriters with respect to the Securities purchased under this Agreement, on the other hand, bear to the total gross proceeds from the offering of the Securities under this Agreement, as set forth in the table on the cover page of the Prospectus. The relative fault shall be determined by reference to whether the untrue or alleged untrue statement of a material fact or omission or alleged omission to state a material fact relates to information supplied by the Company, the Selling Stockholders or the Underwriters, the intent of the parties and their relative knowledge, access to information and opportunity to correct or prevent such statement or omission. The Company, each Selling Stockholder and the Underwriters agree that it would not be just and equitable if contributions pursuant to this Section 10(e) were to be determined by pro rata allocation (even if the Underwriters were treated as one entity for such purpose) or by any other method of allocation which does not take into account the equitable considerations referred to herein. The amount paid or payable by an indemnified party as a result of the loss, claim, damage or liability, or action in respect thereof, referred to above in this Section shall be deemed to include, for purposes of this Section 10(e), any legal or other expenses reasonably incurred by such indemnified party in connection with investigating or defending any such action or claim. Notwithstanding the provisions of this Section 10(e), no Underwriter shall be required to contribute any amount in excess of the amount by which the total price at which the Securities underwritten by it and distributed to the public were offered to the public exceeds the amount of any damages which such Underwriter has otherwise paid or become liable to pay by reason of any untrue or alleged untrue statement or omission or alleged omission. No person guilty of fraudulent misrepresentation (within the meaning of Section 11(f) of the Securities Act) shall be entitled to contribution from any person who was not guilty of such fraudulent misrepresentation. The Underwriters' obligations to contribute as provided in this Section 10(e) are several in proportion to their respective underwriting obligations and not joint. (f) The Underwriters severally confirm, and the Company and each Selling Stockholder each acknowledges, that the statements with respect to the delivery of the Securities by the Underwriters in connection with the public offering of the Securities set forth on the cover page of the Prospectus, and the concession and reallowance figures and the information concerning overallotment transactions, stabilization, short positions and penalty bids and electronic distribution appearing under the caption "Underwriting" in the Prospectus are correct and constitute the only information concerning such Underwriters furnished in writing to the Company through the Representatives by or on behalf of the Underwriters specifically for inclusion in the Registration Statement and the Prospectus. (g) Each of the Selling Stockholders severally confirms and each of the Underwriters acknowledges that the information set forth under the caption "Principal and Selling Stockholders" in the Prospectus regarding such Selling Stockholder are correct and constitute the only information concerning such Selling Stockholder

32 furnished in writing to the Company by or on behalf of such Selling Stockholder specifically for inclusion in the Registration Statement and the Prospectus. 11. Defaulting Underwriters. If, on any Delivery Date, any Underwriter defaults in the performance of its obligations under this Agreement, the remaining non-defaulting Underwriters shall be obligated to purchase the Securities which the defaulting Underwriter agreed but failed to purchase on such Delivery Date in the respective proportions which the number of Firm Securities set forth opposite the name of each remaining non-defaulting Underwriter in Schedule 1 hereto bears to the number of Firm Securities set forth opposite the names of all the remaining non-defaulting Underwriters in Schedule 1 hereto; provided, however, that the remaining non-defaulting Underwriters shall not be obligated to purchase any of the Securities on such Delivery Date if the aggregate number of Securities which the defaulting Underwriter or Underwriters agreed but failed to purchase on such date exceeds 9.09% of the aggregate number of the Securities to be purchased on such Delivery Date, and any remaining non-defaulting Underwriter shall not be obligated to purchase more than 110% of the aggregate number of Securities which it agreed to purchase on such Delivery Date pursuant to the terms of Section 3. If the foregoing maximums are exceeded, the remaining non-defaulting Underwriters, or those other underwriters satisfactory to the Representatives who so agree, shall have the right, but shall not be obligated, to purchase, in such proportion as may be agreed upon among them, the total number of Securities to be purchased on such Delivery Date. If the remaining Underwriters or other underwriters satisfactory to the Representatives do not elect to purchase on such Delivery Date the number of Securities which the defaulting Underwriter or Underwriters agreed but failed to purchase on such Delivery Date, this Agreement shall terminate without liability on the part of any non-defaulting Underwriter or the Company, except that the Company will continue to be liable for the payment of expenses to the extent set forth in Sections 8 and 13. As used in this Agreement, the term "Underwriter" includes, for all purposes of this Agreement unless the context requires otherwise, any party not listed in Schedule I hereto who, pursuant to this Section 11, purchases which a defaulting Underwriter agreed but failed to purchase. Nothing contained herein shall relieve a defaulting Underwriter of any liability it may have to the Company or the Selling Stockholders for damages caused by its default. If other underwriters are obligated or agree to purchase the Securities of a defaulting or withdrawing Underwriter, either the Representatives or the Company may postpone the Delivery Date for up to seven full business days in order to effect any changes that in the opinion of counsel to the Company or counsel for the Underwriters may be necessary in the Registration Statement, the Prospectus or in any other document or arrangement. 12. Termination. The obligations of the Underwriters hereunder may be terminated by the Representatives by notice given to and received by the Company prior to delivery of and payment for the Firm Securities if, prior to that time, any of the events described in Sections 9(m) or 9(n) shall have occurred or if the Underwriters shall decline to purchase the Securities for any reason permitted under this Agreement. 13. Reimbursement of Underwriters' Expenses. If (a) the Company or any Selling Stockholder fails to tender the Securities for delivery to the Underwriters by reason of any failure, refusal or inability on the part of the Company or any Selling Stockholder to perform

33 any agreement on its part to be performed, or because any other condition of the Underwriters' obligations hereunder required to be fulfilled by the Company or the Selling Stockholders is not fulfilled or (b) the Underwriters decline to purchase the Securities for any reason permitted under this Agreement (including the termination of this Agreement pursuant to Section 12), the Company shall reimburse the Underwriters for all reasonable out-of-pocket expenses (including fees and disbursements of counsel) incurred by the Underwriters in connection with this Agreement and the proposed purchase of the Securities, and upon demand the Company shall pay the full amount thereof to the Representatives. If this Agreement is terminated pursuant to Section 11 by reason of the default of one or more Underwriters, neither the Company nor the Selling Stockholders shall be obligated to reimburse any defaulting Underwriter on account of those expenses. 14. Notices, Etc. All statements, requests, notices and agreements hereunder shall be in writing, and: (a) if to the Underwriters, shall be delivered or sent by mail, telex or facsimile transmission to Lehman Brothers Inc., 1285 Avenue of the Americas, 13/th/ Floor, New York, New York 10019, Attention: Syndicate Registration Department (Fax: (212) 526-0973), with a copy, in the case of any notice pursuant to Section 10(d), to the Director of Litigation, Office of the General Counsel, Lehman Brothers Inc., 399 Park Avenue, 10/th/ Floor, New York, NY 10022; and with a copy to Simpson Thacher & Bartlett, 3330 Hillview Avenue, Palo Alto, California 94304 Attention: Kevin Kennedy, Esq. (Fax: (650) 251-5002; Telephone: (650) 251-5130); (b) if to the Company, shall be delivered or sent by mail, telex or facsimile transmission to the address of the Company set forth in the Registration Statement, Attention: Jack B. Dunn (Fax: (410) 224-3552); and with a copy to Piper Rudnick LLP, 6225 Smith Avenue, Baltimore, Maryland 21209, Attention: Richard C. Tilghman, Jr. (Fax: (410) 580-3274); Telephone (410) 580-4274); (c) if to any Selling Stockholder, shall be delivered or sent by mail, telex or facsimile transmission to such Selling Stockholder at the address set forth on Schedule II hereto, with a copy to the counsel, if any, to such Selling Stockholder listed on such schedule; provided, however, that any notice to an Underwriter pursuant to Section 10(d) shall be delivered or sent by mail, telex or facsimile transmission to such Underwriter at its address set forth in its acceptance telex to the Representatives, which address will be supplied to any other party hereto by the Representatives upon request. Any such statements, requests, notices or agreements shall take effect at the time of receipt thereof. The Company and the Selling Stockholders shall be entitled to act and rely upon any request, consent, notice or agreement given or made on behalf of the Underwriters by Lehman Brothers Inc. on behalf of the Representatives and the Company and the Underwriters shall be entitled to act and rely upon any request, consent, notice or

34 agreement given or made on behalf of the Selling Stockholders by either Theordore I. Pincus or Philip R. Jacoby, as attorneys-in-fact. 15. Persons Entitled to Benefit of Agreement. This Agreement will inure to the benefit of and be binding upon the Underwriters, the Company, the Selling Stockholders and their respective successors. This Agreement and the terms and provisions hereof are for the sole benefit of only those persons, except that (A) the representations, warranties, indemnities and agreements of the Company and the Selling Stockholders contained in this Agreement will also be deemed to be for the benefit of the directors, officers and employees of the Underwriters and the person or persons, if any, who control any Underwriter within the meaning of Section 15 of the Securities Act and (B) any indemnity agreement of the Underwriters contained in Section 10(c) of this Agreement will be deemed to be for the benefit of (i) directors, officers and employees of the Company and any person controlling the Company within the meaning of Section 15 of the Securities Act and (ii) directors, officers and employees of any Selling Stockholder and any person controlling such Selling Stockholder within the meaning of Section 15 of the Securities Act. Nothing in this Agreement is intended or shall be construed to give any person, other than the persons referred to in this Section 15, any legal or equitable right, remedy or claim under or in respect of this Agreement or any provision contained herein. 16. Survival. The respective indemnities, representations, warranties and agreements of the Company, the Selling Stockholders and the Underwriters contained in this Agreement or made by or on behalf on them, respectively, pursuant to this Agreement, will survive the delivery of and payment for the Securities and will remain in full force and effect, regardless of any termination or cancellation of this Agreement or any investigation made by or on behalf of any of them or any person controlling any of them. 17. Definition of the Term "Business Day". For purposes of this Agreement, "business day" means any day on which the New York Stock Exchange, Inc. is open for trading. 18. Governing Law. This Agreement shall be governed by and construed in accordance with the laws of New York. 19. Consent to Jurisdiction; Forum Selection; Waiver of Jury Trial. (a) Each of the Underwriters, the Company and each Selling Stockholder hereby submits to the jurisdiction of the courts of the State of New York and the courts of the United States of America located in the State of New York over any suit, action or proceeding with respect to this Agreement or the transactions contemplated hereby. (b) Any suit, action or proceeding with respect to this Agreement or the transactions contemplated hereby may be brought only in the courts of the State of New York or the courts of the United States of America located in the State of New York, located in the Borough of Manhattan, City of New York, State of New York. Each of the parties hereto waives any objection that it may have to the venue of such suit, action or proceeding in any such court or that such suit, action or proceeding in such court was brought in an inconvenient court and agrees not to plead or claim the same.

35 (c) Any right to trial by jury with respect to any lawsuit, claim, action or other proceeding arising out of or relating to this Agreement or is expressly and irrevocably waived. 20. Counterparts. This Agreement may be executed in one or more counterparts and, if executed in more than one counterpart, the executed counterparts shall each be deemed to be an original but all such counterparts shall together constitute one and the same instrument. 21. Headings. The headings herein are inserted for convenience of reference only and are not intended to be part of, or to affect the meaning or interpretation of, this Agreement. [Signature page follows]

36 If the foregoing correctly sets forth the agreement between the Company and the Underwriters, please indicate your acceptance in the space provided for that purpose below. Very truly yours, FTI Consulting, Inc. By ____________________________________ Name: Title: The Selling Stockholders Set Forth in Schedule II Hereto By ____________________________________ Name: Theodore I. Pincus Title: Attorney-in-Fact By ____________________________________ Name: Philip R. Jacoby Title: Attorney-in-Fact Accepted: Lehman Brothers Inc. Banc of America Securities LLC Adams, Harkness & Hill, Inc. Janney Montgomery Scott LLC SunTrust Capital Markets, Inc. By Lehman Brothers Inc. By: ____________________________ Authorized Representative

SCHEDULE I Number of Firm Securities to be Underwriters Purchased - ------------ ---------------- Lehman Brothers Inc. ....................................... ________________ Banc of America Securities LLC ............................. ________________ Adams, Harkness & Hill, Inc. ............................... ________________ Janney Montgomery Scott LLC ................................ ________________ SunTrust Capital Markets, Inc. ............................. ________________ ---------------- Total ............................................ 2,121,969 ================

SCHEDULE II Firm Securities to be Name and Address of Selling Stockholder Sold - --------------------------------------- --------------------- ---------- Edward Bartko/(a)/ 15,969 Kevin Regan/(a)/ 6,000 - --------------------------------------- --------------------- ---------- Total 21,969 (a) This Selling Stockholder is represented by Piper Rudnick LLP, 6225 Smith Avenue, Baltimore, Maryland 21209, Attention: Richard C. Tilghman, Jr. (Fax: (410) 580-3274; Telephone (410) 580-4274), and has appointed Theodore I. Pincus and Philip R. Jacoby, and each of them, as Attorneys-in-Fact for such Selling Stockholder. The address of this Selling Stockholder is 900 Bestgate Road, Suite 100, Annapolis, MD 21401.

SCHEDULE III Lock-Up Letter Agreements to be provided by: Jack B. Dunn, IV Stewart J. Kahn Barry S. Kaufman Theodore I. Pincus Denis J. Callaghan James A. Flick, Jr. Peter F. O'Malley Dennis J. Shaughnessy George P. Stamas Edward Bartko Kevin Regan

ANNEX A LOCK-UP LETTER AGREEMENT Lehman Brothers Inc. on behalf of the several Underwriters (as defined below) c/o Lehman Brothers Inc. 745 Seventh Avenue New York, New York 10019 Dear Ladies and Gentlemen: The undersigned understands that you and certain other firms propose to enter into an Underwriting Agreement (the "Underwriting Agreement") providing for the purchase by you and such other firms (the "Underwriters") of shares (the "Shares") of Common Stock, par value $0.01 per share (the "Common Stock"), of FTI Consulting, Inc. a Maryland corporation (the "Company"), and that the Underwriters propose to reoffer the Shares to the public pursuant to the Underwriting Agreement (the "Offering"). In consideration of the execution of the Underwriting Agreement by the Underwriters, and for other good and valuable consideration, the undersigned hereby irrevocably agrees that, without the prior written consent of Lehman Brothers Inc., on behalf of the Underwriters, the undersigned will not, directly or indirectly, (1) offer for sale, sell, pledge or otherwise dispose of (or enter into any transaction or device which is designed to, or could be expected to, result in the disposition by any person at any time in the future of) any shares of Common Stock or any securities convertible into or exchangeable for Common Stock (other than any of the Shares) or substantially similar securities or sell or grant options, warrants or rights with respect to any shares of Common Stock, securities convertible into or exchangeable for Common Stock or substantially similar securities, or (2) enter into any swap or other derivatives transaction that transfers to another, in whole or in part, any of the economic benefits or risks of ownership of such shares of Common Stock, whether any such transaction described in clause (1) or (2) above is to be settled by delivery of Common Stock or other securities, in cash or otherwise, for a period of 90 days after the date of the final prospectus relating to the Offering. Notwithstanding the foregoing paragraph, the restrictions contained in this Lock-Up Letter Agreement shall not apply to up to an aggregate of 200,000 shares of Common Stock beneficially owned by the Company's officers and directors as a group, but only in the event that the per share closing price of the Common Stock on any trading day that is at least 30 days after the date of the Underwriting Agreement equals or exceeds 110% of the per share offering price specified in the Underwriting Agreement. In furtherance of the foregoing, the Company and its transfer agent are hereby authorized to decline to make any transfer of securities if such transfer would constitute a violation or breach of this Lock-Up Letter Agreement. The undersigned understands that the Company and the Underwriters will proceed with the Offering in reliance on this Lock-Up Letter Agreement. Whether or not the Offering actually occurs depends on a number of factors, including market conditions. Any Offering will only be made pursuant to the Underwriting Agreement, the terms of which are subject to negotiation between the Company, the Underwriters and the Selling Stockholders named therein. In addition, it is understood that, if the Company notifies you that it does not intend to proceed with the Offering, if the Underwriting Agreement is not executed or if the Underwriting Agreement (other than the provisions thereof which survive termination) shall terminate or be terminated

prior to payment for and delivery of the Securities, the undersigned will be released from its obligations under this Lock-Up Letter Agreement. This Agreement shall be governed by, and construed in accordance with, the laws of New York. The undersigned hereby represents and warrants that the undersigned has full power and authority to enter into this Lock-Up Letter Agreement and that, upon request, the undersigned will execute any additional documents necessary in connection with the enforcement hereof. Any obligations of the undersigned shall be binding upon the heirs, personal representatives, successors and assigns of the undersigned. This Lock-Up Letter Agreement does not constitute an offer of any securities for sale. No offer to buy the securities can be accepted and no part of the purchase price can be received until the registration statement to be filed by FTI Consulting, Inc. with the Securities and Exchange Commission has become effective, and any such offer may be withdrawn or revoked, without obligation or commitment of any kind, at any time prior to notice of its acceptance given after the effective date. An indication of interest in response to this Lock-Up Letter Agreement will involve no obligation or commitment of any kind. Very truly yours, By:__________________________ Name: Title: Dated: _______________

[Piper Rudnick LLP Letterhead] Exhibit 5.1 6225 Smith Avenue Baltimore, Maryland 21209-3600 main 410.580.3000 fax 410.580.3001 February 5, 2003 FTI Consulting, Inc. 900 Bestgate Road, Suite 100 Annapolis, MD 21401 Re: Registration Statement on Form S-3 Ladies and Gentlemen: We have acted as counsel to FTI Consulting, Inc., a Maryland corporation (the "Company"), in connection with the Company's Registration Statement on Form S-3, as amended by Amendment Nos. 1, 2 and 3 (the "Registration Statement"; Reg. No. 333-100428), filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission (the "Commission") under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended (the "Act"). The Registration Statement relates the offer and sale of up to 2,440,264 shares (the "Shares") of the Company's Common Stock, par value $.01 per share ("Common Stock"). The Company is selling 2,100,000 of the Shares and 21,969 of the Shares are being sold by various selling stockholders. In addition, the Company has granted the underwriters the right to purchase up to 318,295 additional Shares to cover any over-allotments, if any. In this capacity, we have examined the Registration Statement, the Company's Charter and By-Laws, the resolutions of the Board of Directors of the Company relating to the authorization and issuance of the Shares, and such other documents, corporate records, certificates of public officials, instruments and matters of law as we have deemed necessary to the rendering of this opinion. In such examination, we have assumed the genuineness of all signatures, the authenticity of all documents submitted to us as originals, and the conformity with originals of all documents submitted to us as copies and that all public records reviewed are accurate and complete. We have further assumed (1) that the Shares to be sold by the Company will be issued and sold in accordance with the resolutions adopted by the Board of Directors of the Company and (2) regarding any Shares to be sold upon the exercise of options for such Shares, that such Shares were issued by the Company in accordance with the provisions of the relevant stock option plan and agreement. Subject to and limited by the foregoing, we are of the opinion and advise you that (1) the Shares to be offered by the Company have been duly authorized and will be validly issued, fully paid and nonassessable and (2) the Shares to be sold by the selling stockholders have been duly authorized and validly issued and are fully paid and non-assessable.

FTI Consulting, Inc. February 5, 2003 Page 2 The foregoing opinion is rendered as of the date hereof. We assume no obligation to update this opinion to reflect any facts or circumstances which may, after the date hereof, come to our attention or any changes in the law which may occur, after the date hereof. We hereby consent to the filing of this opinion as Exhibit 5.1 to the Registration Statement and to the use of our name as it appears under the caption "Legal Matters." In giving our consent, we do not thereby admit that we are in the category of persons whose consent is required under Section 7 of the Act or the rules and regulations of the Commission thereunder. Very truly yours, /s/ Piper Rudnick LLP

Exhibit 23.1 CONSENT OF INDEPENDENT AUDITORS We consent to the reference to our firm under the caption "Experts" and to the use of our reports dated November 12, 2002, included in the Registration Statement Amendment No. 3 (Form S-3 No. 333-100428) and related Prospectus of FTI Consulting, Inc. for the registration of 2,121,969 shares of its common stock. /s/ Ernst & Young LLP Baltimore, Maryland February 5, 2003

Exhibit 23.2 INDEPENDENT AUDITORS' CONSENT We consent to the use in this Amendment No. 3 to Registration Statement No. 333-100428 of FTI Consulting, Inc. of our report dated August 9, 2002 appearing in the Prospectus, which is part of such Registration Statement, and to the reference to us under the heading "Experts" in such Prospectus. /s/ DELOITTE & TOUCHE LLP Parsippany, New Jersey February 5, 2003